York Eco2 Ypal 060 User Manual

PACKAGED ROOFTOP  
AIR CONDITIONING UNITS  
Form 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
035-21979-002  
New Release  
INSTALLATION, OPERATION & MAINTENANCE  
YPAL 050  
YPAL 051  
YPAL 060  
YPAL 061  
DESIGN LEVEL F  
SIMPLICITY ELITE CONTROL  
LD13271  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
CHANGEABILITY OF THIS DOCUMENT  
In complying with JOHNSON CONTROLS’s policy  
for continuous product improvement, the information  
contained in this document is subject to change without  
notice. While JOHNSON CONTROLS makes no  
commitment to update or provide current information  
automatically to the manual owner, that information, if  
applicable, can be obtained by contacting the nearest  
JOHNSON CONTROLS Applied Systems office.  
It is the responsibility of operating/service personnel  
to verify the applicability of these documents to the  
equipment in question. If there is any question in  
the mind of operating/service personnel as to the  
applicability of these documents, then prior to working  
on the equipment, they should verify with the owner  
whether the equipment has been modified and if current  
literature is available.  
NOMENCLATURE  
BASE MODEL NUMBER  
YPAL050-061  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
Base Product  
Type  
Nominal Capacity  
Application Refrigerant  
Voltage  
Supply  
Openings  
Return Design Special  
Openings  
Y
P
A
:YORK  
0
0
0
0
5
5
6
6
0
1
0
1
:50 Ton Capacity  
:51 Ton Capacity  
:60 Ton Capacity  
:61 Ton Capacity  
B :R-407C  
C :R-22  
:208/3/60  
:230/3/60  
:460/3/60  
:575/3/60  
:380/3/60  
:400/3/50  
X
S
A
B
:Standard  
2
5
:Packaged Rooftop  
:Air Cooled  
:Scroll  
:Special P  
:Standard  
:Special P  
E
:R-410A  
4
5
4
4
6
8
0
5
L
C
V
F
:Constant Volume  
:VAV, VFD  
:Flexsys  
F
:Revision Level F  
B
R
S
:Bottom Return  
:Rear Return  
:Side Return  
C
N
G
M
F
E
H
S
:Cooling Only  
:Staged Natural Gas Heat  
:Staged Natural Gas Heat SS HX  
:Full Modulating Gas Heat  
:Full Modulating Gas Heat SS Staged HX  
:Electric Heat  
B
L
R
:Bottom Supply  
:Left Supply  
:Right Supply  
:Hot Water Heat  
:Steam Heat  
LD13270  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
3
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
BASE MODEL NUMBER ..............................................................................................................................3  
CHANGEABILITY OF THIS DOCUMENT.....................................................................................................3  
NOMENCLATURE.........................................................................................................................................3  
TABLE OF CONTENTS ................................................................................................................................4  
LIST OF TABLES........................................................................................................................................11  
LIST OF FIGURES ......................................................................................................................................12  
SECTION 1 – INTRODUCTION.........................................................................................................13  
ECOLOGICAL AND ECONOMICAL DESIGN............................................................................................13  
Condensing Section.............................................................................................................13  
Heating Section.....................................................................................................................14  
AIR MANAGEMENT....................................................................................................................................15  
CONTROLS.................................................................................................................................................15  
INDOOR AIR QUALITY ..............................................................................................................................15  
ELECTRICAL ..............................................................................................................................................16  
SERVICE AND INSTALLATION..................................................................................................................16  
SECTION 2 – INSTALLATION...........................................................................................................17  
APPROVALS...............................................................................................................................................17  
LIMITATIONS...............................................................................................................................................17  
UNIT INSPECTION......................................................................................................................................17  
LOCATIONS AND CLEARANCES .............................................................................................................17  
RIGGING AND HANDLING.........................................................................................................................19  
UNIT WEIGHTS...........................................................................................................................................20  
Unit Placement......................................................................................................................21  
Roof Curb Installation ..........................................................................................................22  
PHYSICAL DATA.........................................................................................................................................23  
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING – 050-061 MODELS .................................................................25  
Bottom Supply / Bottom Return..........................................................................................25  
Bottom Supply / Side Return...............................................................................................26  
Bottom Supply / Rear Return...............................................................................................27  
Curb Layout Drawing / 050-061 Models..............................................................................28  
ELECTRICAL DATA....................................................................................................................................29  
Electrical Service Sizing ......................................................................................................29  
Load Definitions: ..................................................................................................................29  
FILTERS ......................................................................................................................................................32  
CONDENSATE DRAIN................................................................................................................................32  
Condensate Drain Piping.....................................................................................................32  
Condensate Drain Trap ........................................................................................................32  
AIR HOODS FOR ECONOMIZER...............................................................................................................33  
AIR HOODS FOR FIXED OUTSIDE AIR (UNITS WITHOUT ECONOMIZER)...........................................33  
AIR HOODS FOR EXHAUST AIR...............................................................................................................33  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
4
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
FIELD WIRING ............................................................................................................................................33  
Thermostat ............................................................................................................................33  
Fan input................................................................................................................................33  
Space Sensor........................................................................................................................33  
CO2 Sensor ...........................................................................................................................34  
Occupied / Unoccupied Input..............................................................................................34  
Shutdown Input.....................................................................................................................34  
Smoke Purge Input...............................................................................................................34  
BAS Economizer Input.........................................................................................................34  
Fault Output ..........................................................................................................................34  
VAV Heat Relay Output.........................................................................................................35  
Supply Air Temperature Reset.............................................................................................35  
COMMUNICATION......................................................................................................................................35  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH..............................................................................................................................35  
FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS..............................................................................................36  
POWER WIRING.........................................................................................................................................37  
ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZING.................................................................................................................37  
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING ...............................................................................................38  
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH.......................39  
DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING...................................................................................................40  
CONTROLS.................................................................................................................................................41  
TRANSDUCER PNEUMATIC TUBING.......................................................................................................42  
Static Pressure Control Plastic Tubing .............................................................................42  
Duct Static Transducer.........................................................................................................42  
Building Pressure Transducer.............................................................................................42  
Static Pressure Probe Installation ......................................................................................42  
DUCT SYSTEM ...........................................................................................................................................44  
Duct Connection Guidelines................................................................................................44  
SOUND AND VIBRATION TRANSMISSION ..............................................................................................44  
GAS HEATING ............................................................................................................................................45  
GAS PIPING................................................................................................................................................45  
GAS CONNECTION....................................................................................................................................45  
Gas Piping Recommendations............................................................................................45  
COMBUSTION VENT..................................................................................................................................46  
SECTION 3 – START-UP...................................................................................................................47  
CRANKCASE HEATERS............................................................................................................................47  
CHECKING THE SYSTEM PRIOR TO INITIAL START (NO POWER)......................................................47  
Unit Checks...........................................................................................................................47  
UNIT CHECKS – POWER APPLIED ..........................................................................................................49  
Verifying Compressor Rotation...........................................................................................49  
Compressor Oil Level Check...............................................................................................49  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
5
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
INITIAL START-UP......................................................................................................................................50  
Refrigerant Charge ..............................................................................................................50  
Checking Superheat and Subcooling.................................................................................50  
Subcooling (R-410A) ............................................................................................................50  
Superheat (R-410A) ..............................................................................................................50  
Leak Checking ......................................................................................................................51  
GAS HEAT MODELS ..................................................................................................................................53  
Pre-Start Checks:..................................................................................................................53  
Post Start Checks:................................................................................................................53  
SECTION 4 – MAINTENANCE..........................................................................................................55  
GENERAL ...................................................................................................................................................55  
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – MONTHLY...................................................................................................55  
Filters.....................................................................................................................................55  
Linkages ................................................................................................................................55  
Compressors.........................................................................................................................55  
Fan Bearing Lubrication .....................................................................................................55  
Recommended Lubricant for Fan Bearings.......................................................................55  
Condenser Coils ...................................................................................................................56  
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – THREE TO SIX MONTHS ..........................................................................56  
Motor Bearing Lubrication...................................................................................................56  
Belt Tension ..........................................................................................................................56  
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – YEARLY......................................................................................................56  
Entire Unit Inspection...........................................................................................................56  
Sheave Alignment: ...............................................................................................................56  
Belts.......................................................................................................................................56  
Belt Replacement..................................................................................................................57  
Belt Tensioning:....................................................................................................................57  
Filter Drier Replacement ......................................................................................................58  
Forward Curved Fans...........................................................................................................58  
Fan Motor ..............................................................................................................................59  
Fan Shaft Bearings...............................................................................................................59  
Bearing Lock Devices ..........................................................................................................60  
Eccentric Type ......................................................................................................................60  
Torquing of Set-screws .......................................................................................................61  
SECTION 5 – SEQUENCE OF OPERATION ....................................................................................63  
UNIT TYPE ..................................................................................................................................................63  
OCCUPIED / UNOCCUPIED MODE...........................................................................................................63  
CONSTANT VOLUME MODE (CV).............................................................................................................63  
Thermostat Input ..................................................................................................................64  
Occupied Cooling ............................................................................................................64  
Unoccupied Cooling........................................................................................................64  
Occupied Heating ............................................................................................................65  
Unoccupied Heating ........................................................................................................65  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
6
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Space Sensor – Hard Wired or Communicated .................................................................65  
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied.............................................................65  
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied .............................................................66  
Stand Alone...........................................................................................................................66  
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied.............................................................67  
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied .............................................................67  
VARIABLE AIR VOLUME (VAV) .................................................................................................................68  
Cooling - Occupied with Thermostat..................................................................................68  
Cooling – Unoccupied with Thermostat.............................................................................69  
Occupied or Unoccupied Heating with a Thermostat .......................................................69  
Occupied Cooling with Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor ............................69  
Cooling – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor .................70  
Heating – Occupied with a Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor ......................70  
Heating – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Communicated Space Sensor ..................70  
Occupied Cooling – Stand Alone........................................................................................71  
Cooling – Unoccupied Stand Alone ...................................................................................72  
Heating – Occupied Stand Alone ........................................................................................72  
Heating – Unoccupied Stand Alone....................................................................................72  
CONDENSER FAN OPERATION ...............................................................................................................72  
COOLING COMPRESSOR LOCKOUT .....................................................................................................72  
Sequence of Operation .......................................................................................................72  
LOW AMBIENT OPERATION ....................................................................................................................73  
Operation and Pressure Control Range .............................................................................73  
Configuration (Jumpers and Potentiometers) ...................................................................73  
SUPPLY FAN OPERATION.........................................................................................................................74  
Constant Volume (CV)..........................................................................................................74  
Variable Air Volume (VAV)....................................................................................................75  
VAV Supply Fan Speed Control...........................................................................................76  
ECONOMIZER.............................................................................................................................................76  
Dry Bulb.................................................................................................................................76  
Single Enthalpy.....................................................................................................................77  
Dual Enthalpy........................................................................................................................77  
BAS ECONOMIZER OPERATION .............................................................................................................77  
Sequence of Operation .......................................................................................................78  
Constant Volume Economizer Set Point ............................................................................78  
Variable Air Volume Economizer Set Point ........................................................................78  
Economizer / Compressor Operation .................................................................................79  
Economizer PI Loop (Proportional and Integral)...............................................................79  
ECONOMIZER LOADING...........................................................................................................................79  
Constant Volume ..................................................................................................................80  
Variable Air Volume ..............................................................................................................80  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
7
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
COMFORT VENTILATION ..........................................................................................................................81  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................82  
Conditions of Operation.......................................................................................................82  
EXCESSIVE SAT (SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE) CONTROL .................................................................82  
Cooling ..................................................................................................................................82  
Heating...................................................................................................................................83  
SPACE SENSOR WITH SET POINT ADJUSTMENT.................................................................................84  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................84  
SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE ........................................................................................85  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................85  
REMOTE CONTROL...................................................................................................................................85  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................85  
REDLINE .....................................................................................................................................................85  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................85  
LOADSHED.................................................................................................................................................86  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................86  
DIRTY FILTER.............................................................................................................................................86  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................86  
METRIC OPERATION.................................................................................................................................86  
INTELLI-START ..........................................................................................................................................86  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................87  
Subsequent Operation .........................................................................................................87  
MORNING WARM-UP.................................................................................................................................88  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................88  
HYDRONIC HEAT .......................................................................................................................................89  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................89  
HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE STAT ..............................................................................................................89  
VENTILATION .............................................................................................................................................89  
Manual ...................................................................................................................................90  
Fixed Minimum......................................................................................................................90  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................90  
Demand Ventilation ..............................................................................................................90  
Definitions ........................................................................................................................91  
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................91  
VENTILATION LOW AMBIENT MINIMUM POSITION RESET ..................................................................91  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................91  
EXHAUST FAN OPERATION .....................................................................................................................92  
On/Off Control Based on Outdoor Damper Position.........................................................92  
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................92  
On/Off Control Based on Building Pressure......................................................................92  
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................93  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
8
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Modulating Damper with Fixed Speed Exhaust.................................................................93  
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................93  
Modulating Exhaust with a VFD ..........................................................................................93  
Sequence of Operation....................................................................................................94  
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE........................................................................................................................94  
Criteria for Operation ...........................................................................................................94  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................94  
ENERGY RECOVERY VENTILATOR .........................................................................................................95  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................95  
LOW VOLTAGE PROTECTION ..................................................................................................................95  
OUTDOOR AIR HEATING LOCKOUT........................................................................................................95  
HOT GAS BYPASS.....................................................................................................................................95  
SPACE TEMPERATURE ALARM...............................................................................................................95  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................96  
SAT ALARM FOR HEATING.......................................................................................................................96  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................96  
Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Heating” Alarm .................................................96  
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm........................................................................97  
SAT ALARM FOR COOLING......................................................................................................................97  
Sequence of Operation ........................................................................................................97  
“Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Cooling” Alarm .................................................97  
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm........................................................................98  
ALARM HISTORY .......................................................................................................................................98  
SECTION 6 – USER INTERFACE .....................................................................................................99  
UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE .............................................................................................................99  
PROGRAM BUTTON ..................................................................................................................................99  
TEST/UP BUTTON....................................................................................................................................100  
ADDRESS/DOWN BUTTON.....................................................................................................................100  
ALARM/CHANGE .....................................................................................................................................100  
CHARACTER DISPLAY ADDRESSES & CODES ...................................................................................100  
COMMUNICATION USING SIMPLICITY PC ............................................................................................104  
Simplicity PC Download.....................................................................................................104  
USB Adapter Drive - Simplicity Pocket PC.......................................................................106  
Establishing Communication ............................................................................................107  
Simplicity PC Data Screens...............................................................................................111  
Revising Settings................................................................................................................126  
SECTION 7 – PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS AND OPTIONS ......................................................141  
SECTION 8 – SERVICE...................................................................................................................153  
ANALOG INPUT OPERATION .................................................................................................................153  
Temperature Sensors.........................................................................................................153  
Duct Pressure Transducer.................................................................................................153  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
9
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE OF CONTENTS  
Return Fan Pressure Transducer......................................................................................154  
Discharge Pressure Transducer........................................................................................154  
Building Pressure Transducer...........................................................................................154  
Suction Pressure Transducer............................................................................................155  
Humidity Sensors ...............................................................................................................155  
CO2 Sensor..........................................................................................................................156  
Furnace Status Input..........................................................................................................156  
FAULTS AND LOCKOUTS .......................................................................................................................160  
Light Emitting Diode...........................................................................................................160  
Alarm Codes........................................................................................................................160  
Alarm Trouble Shooting.....................................................................................................163  
Refrigerant System Alarm Codes (01, 02, 03, 04, 09, 10, 11, 12)................................163  
Low Pressure Cutout Alarm (09, 10, 11, 12).................................................................164  
Limit Switch Alarms (13, 14, 15) ...................................................................................164  
Gas Heating Alarms (16, 17, 18)....................................................................................164  
Space Temperature Sensor Alarm (19) ........................................................................164  
Supply Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (20).................................................................165  
Return Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (21) .................................................................165  
Outdoor Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (22)...............................................................165  
Dirty Filter Switch Alarm (23)........................................................................................165  
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch (24) .............................................................................165  
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch Closed Alarm (25) .....................................................165  
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (26) .............................................................................165  
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (27) .............................................................................165  
Supply Fan Overload Alarm (28)...................................................................................165  
Outdoor Humidity Sensor Alarm (29)...........................................................................166  
Return Humidity Sensor Alarm (30) .............................................................................166  
IAQ (CO2) Sensor Alarm (31) ........................................................................................166  
Time Clock Error Alarm (32)..........................................................................................166  
Space Temperature Offset Alarm (33)..........................................................................166  
CV/VAV Input Alarm (34)................................................................................................166  
Low Voltage Alarm (35)..................................................................................................166  
Smoke Purge Mode Alarm (36) .....................................................................................166  
High Duct Static Pressure Alarm (37) ..........................................................................166  
Supply Air Temperature Cooling Alarm (38)................................................................167  
Supply Air Temperature Heating Alarm (39)................................................................167  
Economizer Minimum Position Alarm (40) ..................................................................167  
Space Temperature Trending Alarm (41) .....................................................................167  
Duct Static Low Pressure Alarm (42) ...........................................................................167  
Hot Water Coil Freeze Alarm (43) .................................................................................167  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
10  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
LIST OF TABLES  
TABLE 2-1 – VOLTAGE LIMITATIONS .............................................................................................17  
TABLE 2-2 – UNIT WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS...........................................................................20  
TABLE 2-3 – UNIT CENTER OF GRAVITY.......................................................................................20  
TABLE 2-4 – UNIT CORNER WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS..........................................................21  
TABLE 2-5 – PHYSICAL DATA – 050-061 MODELS .......................................................................23  
TABLE 2-6 – PHYSICAL DATA - COMPRESSORS..........................................................................24  
TABLE 2-7 – COMPRESSOR DATA - R410A...................................................................................29  
TABLE 2-8 – POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE LIMITS ..........................................................................29  
TABLE 2-9 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - ODP.................................................30  
TABLE 2-10 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - TEFC .............................................30  
TABLE 2-11 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - STANDARD FAN...............................................30  
TABLE 2-12 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - LOW SOUND FAN (FUTURE OPTION) ...........30  
TABLE 2-13 – MISCELLANEOUS ELECTRICAL DATA ..................................................................30  
TABLE 2-14 – ELECTRIC HEAT.......................................................................................................31  
TABLE 2-15 – AIRFLOW AND ENTERING AIR/AMBIENT LIMITATIONS.......................................31  
TABLE 2-16 – THREE PHASE POWER SUPPLY CONDUCTOR SIZE RANGE.............................41  
TABLE 2-17 – SUPPLY AIR DUCT CONNECTION CONFIGURATIONS.........................................44  
TABLE 2-18 – RETURN AIR DUCT CONNECTION CONFIGURATIONS........................................44  
TABLE 2-19 – PIPE SIZES................................................................................................................45  
TABLE 3-1 –R410-A PRESSURE / TEMPERATURE CHART.........................................................52  
TABLE 3-2 – LOW FIRE / HIGH FIRE PRESSURES............................................................................54  
TABLE 3-3 – GAS HEAT PERFORMANCE DATA............................................................................54  
TABLE 4-1 – FAN BEARING – LUBRICATION INTERVALS ...........................................................55  
TABLE 4-2 – SET SCREW TORQUE................................................................................................61  
TABLE 5-1 – BINARY OUTPUTS......................................................................................................73  
TABLE 5-2 – VFD JUMPERS............................................................................................................73  
TABLE 5-3 – POTENTIOMETER SETTINGS....................................................................................73  
TABLE 5-4 OPERATION DURING OFF CYCLE..............................................................................81  
TABLE 5-5 COMPRESSOR ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED................................................81  
TABLE 5-6 HEAT STAGE ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED..................................................82  
TABLE 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST.......................................................................................101  
TABLE 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP .................................................................................130  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS.............................................................................................................141  
TABLE 8-1 – TEMPERATURE SENSOR RESISTANCE ................................................................153  
TABLE 8-2 – DUCT PRESSURE TRANSDUCER...........................................................................154  
TABLE 8-3 – BUILDING PRESSURE TRANSDUCER OUTPUT ...................................................154  
TABLE 8-4 – RETURN FAN PRESSURE TRANSDUCER OUTPUT..............................................154  
TABLE 8-5 – PRESSURE TRANSDUCERS ...................................................................................155  
TABLE 8-6 – HUMIDITY SENSOR OUTPUTS................................................................................155  
TABLE 8-7 – CO2 SENSOR OUTPUT ............................................................................................156  
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA............................................................................................................157  
TABLE 8-9 – ALARM CODE DESCRIPTIONS ...............................................................................161  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
11  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
LIST OF FIGURES  
FIG. 1-1 – PACKAGED ROOFTOP AIR CONDITIONING UNIT ......................................................13  
FIG. 2-1 – UNIT CLEARANCES........................................................................................................18  
FIG. 2-2 – LIFTING LUG LOCATIONS..............................................................................................19  
FIG. 2-3 – UNIT RIGGING .................................................................................................................19  
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING .........................................................................25  
FIG. 2-5 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING ........................................................................28  
FIG. 2-6 DRAIN TRAP SHOWING WATER LOCATION DURING DRAW THROUGH  
OPERATION STAGES......................................................................................................32  
FIG. 2-7 TRAP DETAIL FOR DRAW THROUGH APPLICATION ..................................................32  
FIG. 2-8 – FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS ...................................................................36  
FIG. 2-9 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING.....................................................................38  
FIG. 2-10 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT .........39  
FIG. 2-11 – DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING ......................................................................40  
FIG. 2-12 – ATMOSPHERIC SENSOR PROBE ................................................................................43  
FIG. 2-13 – TYPICAL GAS PIPING CONNECTION..........................................................................45  
FIG. 2-14 – COMBUSTION VENT .....................................................................................................46  
FIG. 3-1 – FAN HOLD DOWN BRACKETS.......................................................................................48  
FIG. 3-2 – MANIFOLD GAS PRESSURE ADJUSTMENT ................................................................54  
FIG. 4-1 – SHEAVE ALIGNMENT......................................................................................................56  
FIG. 4-2 – FAN DATA PLATE - BELT TENSION...............................................................................57  
FIG. 4-3 – BELT TENSIONING GAUGE............................................................................................57  
FIG. 4-4 – EXAMPLE OF FC FAN SHAFT/WHEEL MARKING........................................................58  
FIG. 4-5 – BEARING WITH SETSCREW TYPE LOCKING DEVICE................................................60  
FIG. 4-6 – BEARING WITH ECCENTRIC CAM ................................................................................60  
FIG. 4-7 – ECCENTRIC CAM LOCKING COLLAR BEARING INSTALLATION..............................61  
FIG. 4-8 – SPLIT BEARING...............................................................................................................61  
FIG. 5-1 – CONDENSER FAN VFD POTENTIOMETER SETTINGS................................................73  
FIG. 6-1 – UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE...................................................................................99  
FIG. 8-1 – CONNECTOR LOCATIONS ...........................................................................................157  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
12  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 1 – INTRODUCTION  
1
LD13271  
FIG. 1-1 – PACKAGED ROOFTOP AIR CONDITIONING UNIT  
ECOLOGICAL AND ECONOMICAL DESIGN  
Condensing Section  
High Efficiency eco2 rooftop units are optimized  
for HFC-410A refrigerant. YORK provides the  
FIRST standard product offering that meets the  
latest ASHRAE 90.1 energy efficiency require-  
ments.  
Scroll Compressors – Reliable, efficient,  
trouble-free operation is the true measure of a  
packaged rooftop’s value. That’s why YORK  
eco2 Packaged Rooftop Air Conditioners use  
established scroll-compressor technology to  
deliver dependable, economical performance  
in a wide range of applications. With the eco2  
Packaged Rooftop, you get the latest generation  
of compressor enhancements added to the scroll’s  
inherent strengths. The simplicity of a hermetic  
scroll compressor allows the use of fewer moving  
parts to minimize breakdown.  
Cooling and Heating – Superior operating per-  
formance provides lower operating costs. Smaller  
steps of cooling capacity provide tighter control  
of building environment and occupant comfort  
while optimizing energy efficiency.  
Indoor Air Quality (IAQ) – Outside air econ-  
omizers provide energy savings in free cooling  
mode, and can provide a healthier and more  
comfortable building environment by introducing  
fresh outside air into the building as needed. In-  
doorAir Quality (IAQ) requirements for building  
ventilation and comfort are controlled through  
the microprocessor control panel.  
Multiple Compressor Staging – Through the  
use of the scroll compressor, the eco2 has the abil-  
ity to stage it’s cooling by enabling and disabling  
multiple single stage compressors on multiple  
circuits. These compressors are manifolded to-  
gether in two independent circuits.  
Compressor Circuiting – The eco2 is designed  
so that only 2 scroll compressors are in tandem  
within one refrigeration circuit. This means more  
reliable compressors, and less equipment down  
time. With multiple circuits, if a compressor  
should ever fail on one circuit, the other circuit/s  
will remain operational to work to maintain oc-  
cupied loads. The eco2 system has 2 circuits in  
the unit.  
Premium-Efficiency Motors – Premium-effi-  
ciency motors are available for optimum energy  
efficiency. All motors used on the eco2 packaged  
rooftop air conditioner meet U.S. EPACT 1992  
minimum requirements.  
High-efficiency motors are standard. Motors are  
available in ODP or TEFC construction.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
13  
Introduction  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Heating Section  
Compressor Sound Blankets – Optional factory  
installed sound blankets can be installed to further  
reduce compressor sound attenuation.  
Staged gas heat – The eco2 rooftop gas furnace  
is an induced-draft gas furnace designed for  
high efficiency and reliability. The furnace uses  
an aluminized steel tubular heat exchanger and  
operates at temperatures sufficient to prevent  
acidic exhaust gases from condensing in the  
heat exchanger at low fire rates, unlike drum and  
tube style furnaces that generate condensation  
formation. Up to three stages of heat are avail-  
able.  
Replaceable core filter driers – The optional  
replaceable core filter driers on the eco2 provides  
a convenient means for maintaining and optimiz-  
ing the units refrigeration system. Eliminating  
additional field penetrations into the refrigerant  
circuit, which could lead to potential problems,  
reduce the worry of refrigerant circuit contamina-  
tion.  
Low Ambient Operation – Head-pressure con-  
trol is accomplished via a VFD motor controller  
rather than an inefficient and noisy condenser fan  
damper. By varying the speed of the condenser  
fan, better control and quieter operation is ob-  
tained during the colder months. Low ambient  
controls are available on all systems offering  
higher rooftop cooling capacity than competitive  
units.  
An optional stainless steel heat exchanger is also  
available.  
Electric – The eco2 is also available with an  
electrical heater that can range from 40kW up to  
50kW. Depending on the size of the heat required,  
the eco2 can have 3 steps of control helping to  
provide tighter control of the supply and zone  
conditioned air. With the utilization of this multi  
step function, the eco2 can effectively reduce en-  
ergy consumption by bringing on smaller stages  
of heat while maintaining the maximum level of  
comfort.  
Condenser Fan Motors – The condenser fan  
motors used on the eco2 unit are Totally Enclosed  
Air Over (TEAO) to provide maximum durability  
through any season.  
Steam and Hot water – This option will be  
Condenser Coils – Are available in various  
materials and coatings to suit almost any type of  
application.Aluminum or copper fins, pre-coated  
or post-coated fins are available. The coating is  
applied using an epoxy coating on the aluminum  
coil. Each coil option is beneficial when the unit  
must operate under extreme conditions. The use  
of an epoxy coated coil is recommended for units  
installed in a corrosive environment.  
available in the future.  
Hot Gas By-pass – Is standard on VAV units.  
Condenser Coil Protection – The eco2 is avail-  
able with a wire mesh guard for optimum coil  
protection.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
14  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
AIR MANAGEMENT  
1
The control can also be connected to a computer  
for greater access to programming and operating  
information.  
DWDI Airfoil fans – High efficiency fans are  
used to improve application flexibility, and ad-  
dress sound and application concerns.  
Building pressure control – Exhaust fans and  
barometric relief dampers are available to meet  
building pressure control requirements. Select  
the most appropriate option for a given appli-  
cation.  
Communication -The controller is designed  
to communicate using Modbus RTU protocol.  
Through the addition of a ModLINC translator,  
the unit can also communicate using BACnet  
MS/TP protocol.  
Low sound options – Allow for application of  
the eco2 unit in sound-sensitive applications  
such as theaters and downtown areas. Contact  
JOHNSON CONTROLS for more details on  
site-specific requirements.  
INDOOR AIR QUALITY  
Double Sloped Stainless Steel Drain Pan – The  
eco2’s standard Stainless Steel drain pan meets  
ASHRAE 62 requirements for condensate drain-  
age to improve indoor air quality. Solid wall liners  
encase insulation and prevent moisture damage.  
Additional benefits include easy cleanability and  
isolates insulation from conditioned airstream.  
Variable Frequency Drives – When a VAV unit  
is ordered, the eco2 comes standard with variable  
frequency drives (VFD’s). The VFD can optimize  
a systems performance by modulating the supply  
fan motor speed to reduce energy consumption  
by as much as 40% while maximizing occupant  
comfort.  
Double Wall Construction – Is the standard  
construction of the eco2 and incorporates powder  
coated pre-fabricated outer panels and corner post  
for maximum exterior surface protection.  
Fan Spring Isolation – Two-inch spring isolation  
is used to prevent vibration transmission from the  
rooftop unit’s supply fan to the building.  
CONTROLS  
Rooftop Controller - The unit is designed to  
use the Simplicity Elite control. This control  
has been used with the 25 to 40 ton Millennium  
product for many years. The control is designed  
to operate with conventional room control input.  
This allows the same control to be used on instal-  
lations requiring 25 to 60 tons of cooling.  
The board is equipped with four program but-  
tons and two character displays for use by the  
technician. They allow for access to the most  
important board functions, current operating  
data, and current alarms as well as the last five  
alarms in the history memory buffer. The buttons  
and displays are also used to program the control  
with the correct configuration and set points.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
15  
Introduction  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Factory Shrinkwrap – All eco2 rooftop units  
can be ordered from the factory with an optional  
factory-fresh shrinkwrap packaging. This elimi-  
nates the contractors worries about dirt and debris  
clogging up condenser coils or moisture leaking  
into the air handler on the units way to the job  
site or rigging yard.  
SERVICE AND INSTALLATION  
Access Doors – Full-sized access doors provide  
easy access into the unit for routine maintenance  
and inspection.  
The unit can be purchased with a “Both Side  
Access” option for additional accessibility.  
Service Valves – Oversized service valves to  
provide isolation and quick reclamation and  
charging of system refrigerant are available as  
an option to minimize downtime and simplify  
the service and repair task.  
Demand Ventilation Option – Can be incorpo-  
rated into the unit to improve indoor air quality  
and help manage indoor pollutants such as CO2  
or other harmful airborne contaminates out of  
the occupied spaces for maximum comfort and  
safety. Activation of this sequence can easily be  
accomplished using a CO2 sensor installed in the  
conditioned space. CO2 sensors are typically  
used with demand ventilation; however other  
sensors may be applied to control indoor con-  
taminants such as volatile organic compounds  
(VOCs).  
Convenience Outlet – For maintenance tasks  
requiring power tools, an optional 110V GFCI  
power supply can power lights, drills or any other  
power hand tool needed.  
Factory Run-Tested – Each unit is subjected  
to a series of quality assurance checks as well  
as an automated quality control process before  
being run-tested. Fans and drives are balanced  
at the factory during testing. The factory run-test  
ensures safe proper operation when the unit is  
installed, and reduces installation and commis-  
sioning time.  
Smoke Purge – Is also available to evacuate  
smoke due to fire from a room or zone.  
Filtration – The eco2 is configured for various  
types of filtration to meet the different needs and  
requirements of today's rooftop applications,  
including 2-inch throwaway, pleated, carbon,  
and cleanable filters and 12-inch high efficiency  
rigid filters.  
Gas Heat Sections – Are factory and leaked  
checked.  
Replaceable Core Filter Drier Option – Pro-  
vides a means to remove moisture, dirt and debris  
from the refrigeration circuit in the event it is  
opened.  
ELECTRICAL  
Single Point Power – The eco2 unit comes stan-  
dard with single point power connections to make  
installation quick and easy.  
Dual Point Power – Can be factory installed for  
applications that require the mechanical heating  
and cooling functions to be separated from the  
air handling functions. This enables the unit to  
be operated in an emergency condition while  
minimizing power consumption.  
Unit-Mounted Disconnect – Is available as an  
option to minimize time at installation of equip-  
ment and to reduce necessary field installed  
items.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
16  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 2 – INSTALLATION  
APPROVALS  
Designed certified by CSA, ETL, CETL as follows:  
If the VAV boxes in the conditioned  
space have hydronic heating coils  
installed, it is the responsibility of the  
installing contractor to take appropri-  
ate measures to protect the hydronic  
coils against low unit supply air tem-  
peratures that could result in the freeze  
up and rupture of the coils.  
1.For use as a forced air furnace with cooling unit  
(gas heat models).  
2.For outdoor installation only.  
3.For installation on combustible material and may  
be installed directly on combustible flooring or  
Class A, Class B or Class C roof covering mate-  
rials.  
2
UNIT INSPECTION  
4.For use with natural gas or LP.  
Immediately upon receiving the unit, it should be  
inspected for possible damage, which may have  
occurred during transit. If damage is evident, it should  
be noted in the carrier’s freight bill. A written request  
for inspection by the carrier’s agent should be made at  
once. See “Instruction” manual, Form 50.15-NM for  
more information and details.  
5.When used with LPpropane gas one of the follow-  
ing conversion kits must be installed before the gas  
heat section is fired:  
375,000 BTU Input - 385-01866-001  
750,000 BTU Input - 385-01866-002  
1,125,000 BTU Input - 385-01866-003  
To ensure warranty coverage, this  
equipment must be commissioned and  
serviced by an authorized JOHNSON  
CONTROLS service mechanic or a  
qualified service person experienced  
in packaged rooftop installation.  
Installation must comply with all ap-  
plicable codes, particularly in regard  
to electrical wiring and other safety  
elements such as relief valves, HP  
cut-out settings, design working pres-  
sures, and ventilation requirements  
consistent with the amount and type  
of refrigerant charge.  
Not suitable for use with conventional venting  
systems.  
LIMITATIONS  
The installation of this unit must conform to local  
building codes, or in the absence of local codes, with  
ANSI 223.1 Natural Fuel Gas Code and /or CAN/CGA  
B149 installation codes.  
In U.S.A.:  
1.National Electrical CodeANSI/NFPANo. 70 - Lat-  
est Edition.  
2.National Fuel Gas Code Z223.1 - Latest Edition.  
3.Gas-Fired Central Furnace StandardANSI Z21.47  
- Latest Edition.  
4.Local gas utility requirements.  
Lethal voltages exist within the control  
panels. Before servicing, open and tag  
all disconnect switches.  
TABLE 2-1 – VOLTAGE LIMITATIONS  
UNIT POWER  
VOLTAGE VARIATIONS  
SUPPLY  
MIN. VOLTS  
MAX. VOLTS  
LOCATIONS AND CLEARANCES  
575-3-60  
480-3-60  
230-3-60  
200-3-60  
518  
415  
207  
187  
632  
506  
253  
228  
GENERAL  
The eco2 air conditioning units are designed for outdoor  
installation. When selecting a site for installation, be  
guided by the following conditions:  
Refer to Table 2-15 for airflow and entering air/ambient  
conditions limitations, and Table 2-1 for voltage  
limitations.  
• Unit must be installed on a level surface.  
• For the outdoor location of the unit, select a place  
having a minimum sun exposure and an adequate  
supply of fresh air for the condenser.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
17  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
• Also avoid locations beneath windows or be-  
tween structures.  
• Optional condenser coil protection should be used  
for seashore locations or other harsh environ-  
ments.  
away from sound sensitive areas such as conference  
rooms, auditoriums and executive offices and any other  
room that may have potential for tenant occupancy.  
Possible locations could be above hallways, mechanical  
or utility rooms.  
• The unit should be installed on a roof that is structur-  
ally strong enough to support the weight of the unit  
with a minimum of deflection. It is recommended  
that the unit(s) be installed not more than 15 feet  
from a main support beam to provide proper  
structural support and to minimize the transmis-  
sion of sound and vibration. Ideally, the center of  
gravity should be located over a structural support  
or building column.  
• Location of unit(s) should also be away from  
building flue stacks or exhaust ventilators to  
prevent possible reintroduction of contaminated  
air through the outside air intakes.  
Finally, service clearances should be maintained in  
rooftop design to insure safe access to the unit. Unit  
clearances are designed so that technicians have enough  
space between units, building walls, and edges of  
building to gain access safely. In cases where space is  
limited, please call your local York representative for  
additional information.  
The clearances shown are to provide  
adequate condenser airflow and ser-  
vice access to inside the unit. Addi-  
tional clearance should be considered  
for component replacement such as  
compressors, evaporator coils, and  
supply or exhaust fans.  
• Be sure the supporting structures will not obstruct  
the duct, gas or wiring connections.  
LOCATION  
While it is a common practice to op-  
erate the fan as soon as possible (air  
movement during construction) on the  
job site, the incomplete ductwork and  
missing diffuser grilles will greatly  
reduce air resistance and will allow  
the fan to operate beyond design pa-  
rameters. This practice may result in  
water carry over and flooding of the  
unit. Also, the supply fan motor may  
overamp and become damaged.  
Of the many factors that can effect the location of  
equipment, some of the most important to consider are  
Structural, Acoustical and Service clearances. Proper  
attention should be made at the design stage to ensure  
proper structural support. In cases where equipment is  
being replaced, be aware of building design to insure  
support is adequate for the application.  
The next most important consideration in applying roof  
top equipment is that of sound from the equipment.  
Special care should be made to keep the roof top unit  
LD13267  
NOTES:  
4. 8' service access recommended on one side.  
5. Economizer and exhaust hoods, where applicable, are folded  
inside unit for shipment.  
1. 10' clearance minimal over the top of the condensing unit.  
2. Only one adjacent wall can exceed unit height.  
3. 12' clearance required to adjacent units.  
6. Dim. is to outside of lifting lugs.  
FIG. 2-1 – UNIT CLEARANCES  
18  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
RIGGING AND HANDLING  
Proper rigging and handling of the equipment is  
mandatory during unloading and setting it into position  
to retain warranty status. All lifting lugs must be used  
to prevent twisting and damage to the unit.  
Care must be taken to keep the unit in the upright  
position during rigging and to prevent damage to the  
water-tight seams in the unit casing.Avoid unnecessary  
jarring or rough handling.  
2
Typical rigging using proper spreader bars and cables  
is shown in Figure 2-3. See Figure 2-2 for number  
and location of the lifting lugs by unit size. It is also  
mandatory that an experienced and reliable rigger be  
selected to handle unloading and final placement of  
the equipment. The rigger must be advised that the unit  
contains internal components and that it be handled in  
an upright position. Care must be exercised to avoid  
twisting the equipment structure.  
00543vip  
FIG. 2-3 – UNIT RIGGING  
Unit weights are listed under Table 2-2 in this manual.  
These weights must be referred to when selecting a crane  
for rigging and figuring roof weight loads. Contact your  
JOHNSON CONTROLS Sales Office if you have any  
questions regarding unit weights.  
ꢋꢉ  
ꢁꢂꢃꢄꢅꢆꢇꢀꢗꢇꢕꢘꢃꢈ  
LD13272  
UNIT  
LENGTH  
INCHES  
DIMENSION  
5-6  
UNIT SIZE  
TONS  
1-2  
3-4  
7-8  
9-10  
50 - 61 STD CABINET  
339  
16.91  
79.21  
147.93  
207.81  
315.04  
FIG. 2-2 – LIFTING LUG LOCATIONS  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
19  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
UNIT WEIGHTS  
TABLE 2-2 – UNIT WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS  
MODEL SIZE  
050  
051  
060  
061  
BASIC UNIT*  
7433  
7433  
7800  
7819  
ECONOMIZERS  
NO OUTSIDE AIR  
240  
446  
240  
446  
240  
446  
240  
446  
25% OUTSIDE AIR FIXED POSITION MAUAL  
DAMPER  
25% OUTSIDE AIR 2 POSITION ACTUATED  
DAMPER  
476  
476  
476  
476  
476  
476  
476  
476  
FULL MODULATION WITH MINIMUM POSITION  
POWER EXHAUSTS  
FAN, MOTOR, MODULATING DAMPER AND HOOD  
FAN, MOTOR, VFD, BAROMETRIC DAMPER AND  
HOOD  
501  
506  
501  
506  
501  
506  
501  
506  
GAS HEAT  
375 MBH  
162  
324  
486  
162  
324  
486  
162  
324  
486  
162  
324  
486  
750 MBH  
1125 MBH  
OPTIONS  
OPEN PERIMETER CURB  
CONDENSER COIL WIRE GUARD  
COPPER CONDENSER COILS (ADDITIONAL)  
12” RIGID FILTERS (ADDITIONAL)  
544  
64  
544  
64  
544  
64  
544  
64  
516  
319  
516  
319  
773  
319  
773  
319  
*UNIT INCLUDES FC FAN W/ 20 HP MOTOR, VFD AND 2” THROWAWAY FILTERS  
Center of Gravity  
B
A
C
Condenser  
Coil End  
92  
Y
D
X
339  
LD08298  
TABLE 2-3 – UNIT CENTER OF GRAVITY  
050  
051  
MODEL  
X
Y
X
Y
BASIC UNIT  
184.1  
191.0  
187.4  
50.2  
49.9  
50.0  
184.1  
191.0  
187.4  
50.2  
49.9  
50.0  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER  
EXHAUST  
194.9  
49.5  
194.9  
49.5  
060  
061  
MODEL  
X
Y
X
Y
BASIC UNIT  
179.8  
186.7  
183.5  
49.9  
49.7  
49.8  
179.6  
186.5  
183.2  
50.0  
49.7  
49.8  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER  
EXHAUST  
190.9  
49.3  
190.7  
49.3  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
20  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
UNIT WEIGHTS (CONTINUED)  
TABLE 2-4 – UNIT CORNER WEIGHTS - 050-061 MODELS  
050  
051  
MODEL  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
BASIC UNIT  
1835  
2039  
2118  
2366  
2201  
2417  
2521  
2751  
1852  
1873  
2041  
2034  
1545  
1580  
1715  
1750  
1835  
2039  
2118  
2366  
2201  
2417  
2521  
2751  
1852  
1873  
2041  
2034  
1545  
1580  
1715  
1750  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER  
EXHAUST  
2
060  
061  
MODEL  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
BASIC UNIT  
1894  
2097  
2177  
2424  
2244  
2461  
2565  
2795  
1986  
2008  
2175  
2168  
1676  
1711  
1846  
1881  
1893  
2096  
2176  
2423  
2250  
2466  
2570  
2801  
1997  
2018  
2185  
2178  
1680  
1715  
1850  
1885  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON.  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING  
BASIC UNIT W/ ECON. & HEATING & POWER  
EXHAUST  
Unit Placement  
Elevated – Elevated roof curbs or dunnage steel  
can be used to support the unit in order to raise it  
to specific heights. When this type of placement  
is required, be sure to keep unit access in mind.  
Cat walks or other forms of unit access may be  
required to one or both sides of the unit, depend-  
ing on your area of the country and the local codes  
that are enforced. Please check with local officials  
to ensure the application conforms to local codes  
and regulations.  
Ground Level Locations – It is important that  
the units be installed on a substantial base that  
will not settle, causing strain on the refrigerant  
lines and sheet metal and resulting in possible  
leaks. A one piece concrete slab with footers  
extended below the frost line is highly recom-  
mended.Additionally, the slab should be isolated  
from the main building foundation to prevent  
noise and vibration transmission to the building  
structure.  
For ground level installations, precautions should  
be taken to protect the unit from tampering by, or  
injury to, unauthorized persons. Erecting a fence  
around the unit is common practice.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
21  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ROOF CURB INSTALLATION  
YORK offers an optional roof curb designed specifically  
for the eco2 foot print. This curb comes as an open  
condenser model and is shipped disassembled and  
requires field assembly during installation. Refer to  
the Installation Manual that is shipped with the roof  
curb for specific instructions. For bottom supply and  
return openings, the curb has matching connections to  
ease installation.  
The curb should be located according to the location  
recommendations above, and properly sealed to prevent  
moisture and air leakage into and out of the duct system.  
Flexible collars should be used when connecting the  
duct work to prevent unit noise transmission and  
vibration into the building. The roof curb drawings  
contained in the Johnson Controls literature are not  
intended as construction documents for field fabrication  
of a roof curb. Johnson Controls will not be responsible  
for the unit fit up, leak integrity, or sound level with  
field fabricated roof curbs.  
Construction documents for field fabricated roof curbs  
are available upon request.  
Wood or fiber cant strips, roofing  
felts, roofing material, caulking and  
curb-to-roof fasteners are to be field  
supplied.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
22  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
PHYSICAL DATA  
TABLE 2-5 – PHYSICAL DATA – 050-061 MODELS  
UNIT SIZE  
050  
051  
060  
061  
GENERAL DATA  
LENGTH WITHOUT HOOD (INCHES)  
WIDTH (INCHES)  
339  
92  
339  
92  
339  
92  
339  
92  
HEIGHT (INCHES)  
UNIT EER/ IPLV  
82  
82  
82  
82  
10.3 / 10.9  
10.2 / 10.6  
10.1 / 10.4  
10.1 / 10.3  
UNIT EER/ IPV GAS HEAT  
COMPRESSOR DATA (SEE TABLE 2-6)  
QUANTITY  
2
4
SCROLL  
4
4
SCROLL  
4
4
SCROLL  
4
4
SCROLL  
4
TYPE  
UNIT CAPACITY STEPS  
REFRIGERANT (410A)  
SYSTEM 1  
50 lbs - 0 oz  
50 lbs - 0 oz  
50 lbs - 0 oz  
50 lbs - 0 oz  
58 lbs - 11 oz  
58 lbs - 11 oz  
58 lbs - 11 oz  
58 lbs - 11 ozs  
SYSTEM 2  
SUPPLY FAN  
QUANTITY  
TYPE  
1
FC  
1
FC  
1
FC  
1
FC  
SIZE  
28 - 28  
28 - 28  
28 - 28  
28 - 28  
MOTOR SIZE RANGE (HP)  
AIR FLOW RANGE (CFM) COOLING MIN.  
STATIC PRESSURE RANGE (TOTAL)  
OPTIONAL SUPPLY FAN  
QUANTITY  
10 - 40  
10,000 - 22,500  
1.0” - 6.0”  
10 - 40  
10,000 - 22,500  
1.0” - 6.0”  
10 - 40  
12,500 - 24,000  
1.0” - 6.0”  
10 - 40  
10,000 - 24,000  
1.0” - 6.0”  
1
AF  
1
AF  
1
AF  
1
AF  
TYPE  
SIZE  
28  
28  
28  
28  
MOTOR SIZE RANGE (HP)  
AIR FLOW RANGE (CFM) COOLING MIN.  
STATIC PRESSURE RANGE (TOTAL)  
EXHAUST FAN  
10 - 40  
10,000 - 22,500  
1.0” - 8.0”  
10 - 40  
10,000 - 22,500  
1.0” - 8.0”  
10 - 40  
10,000 - 24,000  
1.0” - 8.0”  
10 - 40  
10,000 - 24,000  
1.0” - 8.0”  
QUANTITY FANS/MOTORS  
TYPE  
2 / 1  
FC  
2 / 1  
FC  
2 / 1  
FC  
2 / 1  
FC  
SIZE  
18 - 18  
18 - 18  
18 - 18  
18 - 18  
MOTOR SIZE RANGE (HP)  
AIR FLOW RANGE (CFM)  
STATIC PRESSURE RANGE (TOTAL)  
EVAPORATOR COIL  
SIZE (SQUARE FEET)  
ROWS/FPI  
5 - 20  
4,000 - 22,500  
0.1” - 1.5”  
5 - 20  
4,000 - 22,500  
0.1” - 1.5”  
5 - 20  
4,000 - 24,000  
0.1” - 1.5”  
5 - 20  
4,000 - 24,000  
0.1” - 1.5”  
52  
3 / 17  
52  
3 / 17  
52  
4 / 17  
52  
4 / 17  
CONDENSER COIL  
SIZE (SQUARE FEET)  
ROWS/FPI  
88  
2 / 17  
88  
2 / 17  
88  
3 / 17  
88  
3 / 17  
CONDENSER FANS  
QUANTITY  
4
PROP.  
36  
4
PROP.  
36  
4
PROP.  
36  
4
PROP.  
36  
TYPE  
DIAMETER (INCHES)  
MOTOR HP  
2
2
2
2
FILTERS - 2” THROWAWAY (PRE-FILTER POSITION)  
QUANTITY  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
61.6  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
61.6  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
61.6  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
61.6  
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)  
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)  
FILTERS - 2” CLEANABLE (PRE-FILTER POSITION)  
QUANTITY  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)  
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
23  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
PHYSICAL DATA (CONTINUED)  
TABLE 2-5 – PHYSICAL DATA - 050-061 MODELS (CONTINUED)  
UNIT SIZE  
FILTERS - 2” PLEATED, 30% EFFICIENT (PRE-FILTER POSITION)  
QUANTITY  
050  
051  
060  
061  
8 / 12  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)  
FILTERS -12” RIGID 65%, 2” 30% PREFILTER (PRE-FILTER POSITION)  
QUANTITY  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)  
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)  
43.0  
43.0  
43.0  
43.0  
FILTERS -12” RIGID 95%, 2” 30% PREFILTER (PRE-FILTER POSITION)  
QUANTITY  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 4 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)  
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)  
44.6  
44.6  
44.6  
44.6  
FILTERS - 2” CARBON (PRE-FILTER POSITION)  
QUANTITY  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
8 / 12  
25X16 / 25X20  
63.9  
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)  
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)  
FILTERS - 12” RIGID 95% IN POST-FILTER POSITION  
QUANTITY  
1 / 3 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 3 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 3 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
1 / 3 / 9  
16X20/25X16/  
25X20  
SIZE (LENGTH X WIDTH) (IN.)  
TOTAL FILTER FACE AREA (SQUARE FEET)  
41.8  
41.8  
41.8  
41.8  
GAS FURNACES  
375 MBH / 300 MBH / 1 STEP  
750 MBH / 600 MBH / 2 STEPS  
1125 MBH / 900 MBH / 3 STEPS  
STAGED FURNACE SIZES (INPUT/OUTPUT/STEPS)  
GAS PRESSURE RANGE  
375 MBH  
4.5-13.5" WC  
7,500  
4.5-13.5" WC  
7,500  
4.5-13.5" WC  
11,500  
4.5-13.5" WC  
11,500  
AIRFLOW RANGE  
750 MBH  
14,000  
21,000  
40.0 °F  
0.0 °F  
14,000  
21,000  
40.0 °F  
0.0 °F  
14,000  
21,000  
40.0 °F  
0.0 °F  
14,000  
21,000  
40.0 °F  
0.0 °F  
(MIN HEATING)  
1125 MBH  
MINIMUM OA TEMP FOR MECH. CIG.  
LOW AMBIENT OPTION MIN. OA TEMP  
TABLE 2-6 – PHYSICAL DATA - COMPRESSORS  
COMPRESSORS UTILIZED  
COMPRESSOR NOMINAL TONS  
SYSTEM 1 SYSTEM 2  
“COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “COMPR “STAGE “STAGE “STAGE “STAGE  
CAPACITY %  
SYSTEM 1  
SYSTEM 2  
# 1”  
# 2”  
# 3”  
# 4”  
# 1”  
# 2”  
# 3”  
# 4”  
1”  
2”  
3”  
4”  
050  
051  
060  
061  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP182  
ZP182  
ZP120  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP182  
ZP182  
ZP120  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP154  
13.58  
13.58  
17.95  
17.95  
12.53  
13.58  
13.30  
13.30  
13.58  
13.58  
17.95  
17.60  
12.53  
13.58  
13.30  
14.86  
26.0  
25.0  
28.7  
28.2  
52.0  
50.0  
57.4  
55.8  
76.0  
75.0  
78.7  
76.7  
100.0  
100.0  
100.0  
100.0  
MODEL  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
24  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING – 050-061 MODELS  
BOTTOM SUPPLY / BOTTOM RETURN  
2
O A  
O A  
LD08295  
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
25  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWINGS (CONTINUED)  
BOTTOM SUPPLY / SIDE RETURN  
O A  
O A  
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING (CONT.)  
26  
LD08370  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWINGS (CONTINUED)  
BOTTOM SUPPLY / REAR RETURN  
2
O A  
O A  
LD08296  
FIG. 2-4 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING (CONT.)  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
27  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
CURB LAYOUT DRAWING / 050-061 MODELS  
333.69  
41.19  
66.08  
35.10  
21.00  
66.19  
84.50  
71.83  
1.75  
TYP  
229.56  
14.00  
LD08297  
NOTES:  
1. Unit must be installed square and level.  
2. Curb configuration for “bottom” return and “bottom” supply.  
3, These drawings are not intended as construction documents for the field fabricated roof curbs. Johnson Controls will not be responsible for  
the unit fit up, leak integrity, or sound level for installation using field fabricated roof curbs.  
4. The YPAL unit does not have a base pan under the condensing section of the unit. Field fabricated roof curbs must have a cap on the top of  
the condensing section of the curb to prevent moisture from entering the space. The cap design must be sloped away from the supply duct  
opening to the end of the unit for the drainage of the moisture off of the top of the cap.  
FIG. 2-5 – GENERAL ARRANGEMENT DRAWING  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
28  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ELECTRICAL DATA  
ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZING  
In order to use the electrical service required for  
the cooling only eco2 rooftop, use the appropriate  
calculations listed below from U.L. 1995. Based on the  
configuration of the rooftop, the calculations will yield  
different MCA (minimum circuit ampacity), and MOP  
(maximum overcurrent protection).  
Using the following load definitions and calculations,  
determine the correct electrical sizing for your unit. All  
concurrent load conditions must be considered in the  
calculations, and you must use the highest value for any  
combination of loads.  
LOAD3 is the current of the electric heaters  
– zero for cooling only units.  
LOAD4 is the sum of any remaining currents  
greater than or equal to 1.0 amp.  
Use the following calculations to determine MCA  
and MOP for units supplied with a single-point power  
connection:  
MCA = (1.25 x LOAD1) + LOAD2 + LOAD3 + LOAD4  
MOP = (2.25 x LOAD1) + LOAD2 + LOAD3 + LOAD4  
If the MOP does not equal a standard current rating  
of an overcurrent protective device, then the marked  
maximum rating is to be the next lower standard rating.  
However, if the device selected for MOP is less than the  
MCA, then select the lowest standard maximum fuse  
size greater than or equal to the MCA.  
2
Load Definitions:  
LOAD1 is the current of the largest motor – com-  
pressor or fan motor.  
LOAD2 is the sum of the remaining motor cur-  
rents that may run concurrently with LOAD1.  
TABLE 2-7 – COMPRESSOR DATA - R410A  
NOMINAL VOLTAGE  
MODEL  
MODEL  
208-230/3/60  
RLA*  
460/3/60  
575/3/60  
LRA  
239  
245  
239  
245  
245  
245  
245  
245  
245  
340  
245  
340  
300  
340  
245  
340  
RLA*  
17.9  
18.6  
17.9  
18.6  
18.6  
18.6  
18.6  
18.6  
18.6  
26.9  
18.6  
26.9  
22.4  
25.0  
18.6  
25.0  
LRA  
125  
125  
125  
125  
125  
125  
125  
125  
125  
172  
125  
172  
150  
172  
125  
172  
RLA*  
12.8  
14.7  
12.8  
14.7  
14.7  
14.7  
14.7  
14.7  
14.7  
23.7  
14.7  
23.7  
19.8  
23.7  
14.7  
23.7  
LRA  
80  
1A  
1B  
2A  
2B  
1A  
1B  
2A  
2B  
1A  
1B  
2A  
2B  
1A  
1B  
2A  
2B  
ZP120  
ZP137  
ZP121  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP137  
ZP182  
ZP137  
ZP182  
ZP154  
ZP182  
ZP137  
ZP182  
33.3  
48.0  
33.3  
48.0  
48.0  
48.0  
48.0  
48.0  
48.0  
55.7  
48.0  
55.7  
51.3  
55.7  
48.0  
55.7  
100  
80  
050  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
132  
100  
132  
109  
132  
100  
132  
051  
060  
061  
TABLE 2-8 – POWER SUPPLY VOLTAGE LIMITS  
POWER SUPPLY  
208/230V/3PH/60HZ  
460V/3PH/60HZ  
MINIMUM VOLTAGE  
MAXIMUM VOLTAGE  
187  
414  
518  
253  
506  
632  
575V/3PH/60HZ  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
29  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ELECTRIC DATA (CONTINUED)  
TABLE 2-9 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - ODP  
HIGH EFFICIENCY  
PREMIUM EFFICIENCY  
NOMINAL VOLTAGE  
NOMINAL VOLTAGE  
MOTOR  
HP  
MOTOR  
HP  
208/3/60  
FLA  
14.0  
21.7  
28.2  
41.0  
53.0  
66.0  
84.0  
106.0  
230/3/60  
FLA  
13.8  
20.0  
26.0  
38.0  
48.0  
62.0  
72.0  
98.0  
380/3/60  
FLA  
8.3  
13.3  
17.5  
24.5  
32.0  
39.0  
46.0  
59.0  
460/3/60  
FLA  
6.9  
10.0  
13.0  
19.0  
24.0  
31.0  
36.0  
49.0  
575/3/60  
FLA  
5.3  
208/3/60  
FLA  
13.8  
20.0  
26.0  
37.4  
49.4  
63.3  
74.1  
97.5  
230/3/60  
FLA  
13.2  
19.4  
25.0  
35.4  
47.0  
60.0  
70.0  
92.0  
460/3/60  
FLA  
6.6  
575/3/60  
FLA  
5.2  
5
5
7.5  
10  
15  
20  
25  
30  
40  
8.2  
7.5  
10  
15  
20  
25  
30  
40  
9.7  
7.4  
11.0  
16.2  
19.8  
23.8  
29.0  
38.8  
12.5  
17.7  
23.5  
30.0  
35.0  
46.0  
10.3  
14.1  
18.9  
24.2  
28.0  
37.4  
TABLE 2-10 – SUPPLY AND EXHAUST FAN MOTOR DATA - TEFC  
HIGH EFFICIENCY  
PREMIUM EFFICIENCY  
NOMINAL VOLTAGE  
NOMINAL VOLTAGE  
MOTOR  
HP  
MOTOR  
208/3/60  
FLA  
15.4  
21.2  
27.5  
40.0  
54.0  
64.0  
78.0  
101.0  
230/3/60  
FLA  
14.2  
19.6  
25.6  
37.0  
50.0  
60.0  
72.0  
94.0  
380/3/60  
FLA  
8.1  
460/3/60  
FLA  
7.1  
575/3/60  
FLA  
5.4  
208/3/60  
FLA  
13.6  
21.0  
26.0  
38.9  
51.0  
63.3  
77.0  
99.0  
230/3/60  
FLA  
13.0  
18.8  
25.0  
37.0  
48.0  
60.0  
72.0  
92.0  
460/3/60  
FLA  
6.5  
575/3/60  
FLA  
5.2  
HP  
5
5
7.5  
10  
15  
20  
25  
30  
40  
12.0  
16.8  
23.8  
30.0  
39.0  
46.0  
57.0  
9.8  
8.2  
7.5  
10  
15  
20  
25  
30  
40  
9.4  
8.0  
12.8  
18.5  
25.0  
30.0  
36.0  
47.0  
11.4  
15.3  
19.1  
25.0  
29.6  
38.0  
12.5  
18.5  
24.0  
30.0  
36.0  
46.0  
10.0  
14.8  
19.0  
23.9  
29.0  
36.8  
TABLE 2-11 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - STANDARD FAN  
208V/3PH/60HZ  
230V/3PH/60HZ  
460V/3PH/60HZ  
3.1  
575V/3PH/60HZ  
2.5  
RLA EACH MOTOR  
7.3  
6.2  
QUANTITY OF  
MODEL  
208V/3PH/60HZ  
230V/3PH/60HZ  
460V/3PH/60HZ  
575V/3PH/60HZ  
FANS  
50-61 TONS  
4
29.2  
24.8  
12.4  
10.0  
TABLE 2-12 – CONDENSER FAN MOTOR RLA - LOW SOUND FAN (FUTURE OPTION)  
208V/3PH/60HZ  
230V/3PH/60HZ  
460V/3PH/60HZ  
575V/3PH/60HZ  
2.5  
RLA EACH MOTOR  
7.3  
6.2  
3.1  
QUANTITY OF  
MODEL  
208V/3PH/60HZ  
230V/3PH/60HZ  
460V/3PH/60HZ  
575V/3PH/60HZ  
FANS  
50-61 TONS  
4
32.4  
27.6  
13.6  
12.0  
TABLE 2-13 – MISCELLANEOUS ELECTRICAL DATA  
NOMINAL VOLTAGE  
DESCRIPTION  
208 / 230V  
AMPS  
2.4  
460V  
AMPS  
1.1  
575V  
AMPS  
0.9  
380V-60  
AMPS  
2
CONTRL X’FMR. 500 VA  
CONVENIENCE OUTLET  
GAS HEAT  
9.6  
4.4  
3.5  
N/A  
9.6  
4.4  
3.5  
5.3  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
30  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ELECTRIC DATA (CONTINUED)  
TABLE 2-14 – ELECTRIC HEAT  
NOMINAL VOLTAGE  
KW  
208/3/60  
AMPS  
230/3/60  
AMPS  
460/3/60  
AMPS  
575/3/60  
AMPS  
2
40  
80  
96  
193  
260  
96  
193  
260  
48  
96  
40  
80  
108  
150  
130  
181  
109  
151  
TABLE 2-15 – AIRFLOW AND ENTERING AIR/AMBIENT LIMITATIONS  
Limitations  
Model Size  
51 60  
10000 - 10000 - 12500 - 12500 -  
50  
61  
Minimum  
Airflow at  
22500  
22500  
24000  
24000  
Standard Design  
Conditions.  
CFM*  
(min to max)  
Entering Wet  
Bulb Temp F°  
(min/max)  
57/75  
68/90  
57/75  
68/90  
50/120  
0/120  
57/75  
68/90  
50/120  
0/120  
57/75  
68/90  
50/120  
0/120  
Entering Dry  
Bulb Temp F°  
(min/max)  
Ambient Temp F° 50/120  
without Low  
Amb option  
Ambient Temp F°  
with Low Amb  
option  
0/120  
* Cooling Only Units  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
31  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
FILTERS  
into the supply duct and/or causing water damage in  
the building. A trap must be installed to prevent this  
condensate water build-up (see Figures 2-6 & 2-7).  
Two-inch “throwaway” filters are standard and factory  
installed in a filter rack located prior to the evaporator  
coil. Any optional pre-filters ordered with the unit will  
be shipped inside the unit, but must be field installed.  
The unit can also be ordered with an extended cabinet  
and 95% efficient post-filters. These post-filters are  
installed at the factory.  
Under high latent load conditions condensate may  
form in the base and side rails of the unit. The unit is  
designed to contain this moisture and prevent it from  
leaking into the conditioned space. In order to dispose  
of this condensate, two condensate drain connections  
are located on the side rails on each side of the unit  
and in the base rail on the return end of the unit. There  
are five (5) condensate drains on the unit. Since these  
connections are also under negative pressure, they must  
be trapped using the same design criteria as the main  
drain pan.  
Pre-filters must always be installed ahead of the  
evaporator coil. Post and pre-filters must be kept clean  
and replaced with the same size and type as shipped with  
the unit. Dirty filters will reduce the capacity of the unit  
and may result in frosted coils and safety shutdowns.  
Required filter sizes and quantities are shown in Table  
2-6. The unit should never be operated for any length  
of time without the proper filters installed in the unit.  
"H" must be at least  
1 inch plus fan total  
static pressure  
BASE  
RAILS  
TRAP  
DRAIN  
NIPPLE  
NO.1 - FAN OFF  
BASE  
RAILS  
"X" = 1/2 "H"  
NO. 2 - TRAP CONDITION WHEN FAN STARTS  
LD05370-1  
BASE  
RAILS  
FIG. 2-7 TRAP DETAIL FOR DRAW THROUGH  
APPLICATION  
COOLING COIL  
DRAIN PAN  
Condensate Drain Trap  
NO. 3 - FAN RUNNING AND CONDENSATE  
LD13269  
For “Draw-through” applications install a trapped  
condensate drain line at unit drain connection (see  
Figure 2-7 according to all governing codes. “H”  
dimension must be at least 1 inch greater than design  
Total Static Pressure (TSP) of fan.  
FIG. 2-6 DRAIN TRAP SHOWING WATER  
LOCATION DURING DRAW THROUGH  
OPERATION STAGES  
CONDENSATE DRAIN  
The trap and drain lines should be protected from  
freezing. Plumbing must conform to local codes. Use  
a sealing compound on male pipe threads. Install  
condensate drain lines from the 1-1/4 inch NPT female  
connections on the unit to an open drain.  
Condensate Drain Piping  
The eco 2 cooling coils are located in the units so that  
the supply air is drawn through them. This results in  
the condensate being subjected to negative (-) static  
pressure. Unless some means of pressure equalization is  
provided in the condensate drains, the air rushing back  
through the drainpipe will cause the condensate to build  
up in the base rails.As the unit continues to operate, the  
accumulated water will be carried with the air stream,  
overfilling the base rails causing possible water leaks  
The unit must be properly trapped and  
charged with water before the units  
are started.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
32  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
AIR HOODS FOR ECONOMIZER  
There are two (2) economizer outside air intake hoods  
provided with the unit. The front and rear hoods are  
made operational per the following instructions:  
The thermostat should be mounted on an inside wall  
approximately 56” above the floor where it will not be  
subject to drafts, sun exposure or heat from electrical  
fixtures or appliances.  
• Remove the screws holding the economizer hood  
shipping covers in place. Discard covers.  
• Apply a bead of RTV sealer along the edge of  
both hoods and each pivot joint to prevent water  
leakage.  
• Rotate the hoods out (each hood is hinged).  
Secure the hoods with screws along the top and  
sides.  
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1  
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24  
VAC source for the input to the thermostat. Use of any  
power source external to the controller will result in  
damage to the Unit Controller.  
2
Fan input  
• Seal any unused screw holes with RTV or by  
replacing the screw.  
By closing a contact between terminal (R) and (G) on  
terminal block P1 on the Simplicity control board the  
supply fan can be turned on. This function is typically  
used on CV units and is included with most room  
thermostats.  
AIR HOODS FOR FIXED OUTSIDE AIR  
(UNITS WITHOUT ECONOMIZER)  
The hoods must be installed per the above instructions.  
The dampers may be adjusted by loosening the thumb  
screw, turning the lever to the desired position, and  
retightening the thumb screw.  
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1  
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24  
VAC source for the input to (G). Use of any power  
source external to the controller will result in damage  
to the Unit Controller.  
AIR HOODS FOR EXHAUST AIR  
Space Sensor  
No hoods are required for the exhaust air outlet.  
A space sensor can be used in lieu of a thermostat as  
the primary means of control on a CV unit. The space  
sensor is connected to terminals (ST) and (GND) of  
terminal block P8 on the Simplicity control board.  
FIELD WIRING  
Figure 2-8 shows the field wiring to the Simplicity  
control board. All field control wiring is field supplied  
and installed.  
A space sensor with a 20,000 potentiometer can be  
used to reset the space temperature set point. The  
space temperature reset is connected to terminals (SSO)  
and (GND) of terminal P8 on the Simplicity control  
board.  
Thermostat  
Athermostat (4 stage cool and 3 stage heat) can be used  
on CV and VAV units. On CV units the thermostat is  
the primary means of control for the unit. The three  
thermostat heating inputs connect to the P2 terminal  
block on the Simplicity control board to terminals W1,  
W2, andW3. The four thermostat cooling inputs connect  
to the P2 and P3 terminal block on the Simplicity control  
board to terminals Y1, Y2, Y3, and Y4.  
When mounting a space sensor, it should be located on  
an inside wall approximately 56” above the floor where  
it will not be subject to drafts, sun exposure, or heat  
from electrical fixtures or appliances.  
Shielded wire must be used that is  
grounded at the control panel only.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
33  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
CO2 Sensor  
Smoke Purge Input  
The addition of a field installed CO2 sensor is required  
for Demand Ventilation operation. The default input  
span for the control is 0 to 2,000 ppm with an output  
voltage range of 0 to 10 VDC. The field will need to  
supply an external power supply for the sensor. This is in  
addition to the two wires connect to the unit. The sensor  
connects to terminals (DV+) and (DV-) of terminal  
block P20 on the Simplicity control board. The wiring  
to the sensor should be a twisted shield pair grounded  
on one end.  
A contact closure input (PURGE) is provided to place  
the unit in smoke purge mode. When the contact is  
closed the unit will operate as follows:  
• Turn off all heating and cooling operation  
• Set the outdoor air damper output to 100%  
• Close the return to 0%  
• Turn the supply fan on  
• On VAV units set the supply fan output to  
100%  
• Turn the power exhaust fan on  
• On VFD driven exhaust fans set the exhaust fan  
output to 100%  
Occupied / Unoccupied Input  
A contact closure input to terminal (OCC) of the P1  
terminal block on the Simplicity control board is  
provided for hard-wiring an external device such as a  
central time clock, a thermostat with scheduling, or a  
manual switch to switch the unit from Unoccupied to  
Occupied mode.  
Note that 24 volts terminal (R) on the Simplicity  
control board must be used as the 24 VoltAC source for  
switch the contact to the Unit Controller Smoke Purge  
(PURGE) input. Use of any power source external to the  
controller will result in damage to the Unit Controller.  
Closed Circuit – Occupied  
Open Circuit – Unoccupied  
BAS Economizer Input  
The Simplicity control board has the capability to  
control the economizer damper through a 2 – 10 Volt  
DC input. Refer to BAS Economizer Input information  
contained in Section 5 of the manual for additional  
information on the programming and operation of this  
feature.  
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1  
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24  
VAC source for the input to (OCC). Use of any power  
source external to the controller will result in damage  
to the Unit Controller.  
Shutdown Input  
The 2 to 10 VDC input connects to terminals (BAS  
ECON +) and (BAS ECON –) at terminal block P3 of  
the Simplicity control board  
A jumper is installed between terminal “R” and “SD1”  
on the Simplicity control board. To install a hard-wired  
shutdown circuit, remove the jumper between the two  
terminals and connect a switch between the terminals.  
The switch must be closed for operation and open for  
shutdown. Opening the switch removes the 24 VAC  
power to the Unit Controller.  
Fault Output  
The Simplicity control board has the capability out  
sending a positive half wave 24 VAC output whenever  
an alarm is present. It is capable of driving a 25 ma load.  
This is design to connect to a fault light on a commercial  
thermostat. This output originates at terminal (X) at  
terminal block P1 on the Simplicity control board.  
Closed Circuit – Normal Operation  
Open Circuit – Shutdown  
Note that 24 VAC terminal (R) on terminal block P1  
of the Simplicity control board must be used as the 24  
VAC source for the input to (SD). Use of any power  
source external to the controller will result in damage  
to the Unit Controller.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
34  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
COMMUNICATION  
VAV Heat Relay Output  
The Simplicity Unit Controller is designed to  
communicate using Modbus Client protocol. Through  
the use of a ModLINC translator the unit can also  
communicate using BACnet MS/TP protocol.  
This is a 24 VDC output that is turned on when the  
unit is in the heating mode. The field can use this as  
a signal to trigger the opening of the VAV boxes for  
heating operation. This feature uses two ¼ inch male  
tabs identified as (VAV OPEN +) and (VAV OPEN -)  
on the Simplicity control board.  
2
Through the use of a FREEnet Serial or USB adapter  
the Simplicity Unit Controller can be connected directly  
to a computer. Multiple units can be daisy chained  
together and through the use of the adapter connected to  
a computer or a network. This allows remote monitoring  
of the unit as well as the ability to change settings and  
options from a remote location.  
Supply Air Temperature Reset  
An external 0 to 10 VDC input can be applied to  
terminals (REM+) and (REM-) at terminal block P19  
on the Simplicity control board to reset the supply air  
temperature set point for VAV operation. The units  
follows interprets the voltage input as follows:  
Connection to the unit is done through either of two  
RS-485 connections. The P4 terminal block has screw  
connections with terminal A being the – and terminal  
B being the +. The P5 connecter is designed to allow  
the mating connector from the FREEnet Serial or USB  
adapter to be plugged in.  
Below 1.0 VDC – the blower is de-energized  
Below 1.5 VDC – the cooling and heating is  
disabled  
At 2.0 VDC – the control uses the lower set  
point  
See Table 6-1 for parameter points list.  
Between 2.0 VDC and 10 VDC the change in set  
point is proportional to the change in voltage.  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH  
At 10.0 VDC – the control uses the upper set  
point  
On units with a dirty filter switch option, an adjustable  
differential pressure switch is installed to monitor the  
pressure drop across the filters. When the pressure  
drop across the filters exceeds the setting of the switch,  
the switch closes sending a 24-volt signal to the Unit  
Controller. The Unit Controller posts a warning in  
the service memory buffer; but will not shut down the  
unit.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
35  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS  
Wiring Notes:  
1. Wiring shown indicates typical wiring. Refer to the IOM manual for more detailed wiring methods and options.  
2. All wiring is Class 2, low voltage.  
3. Maximum power available from the 24 VAVC terminal is 40 VA.  
4. Use shielded wire where shown.  
10 WIRE THERMOSTAT  
C (Common)  
R (24 VAC)  
C
R
FAULT  
LIGHT  
(Optional)  
X
G
G (Fan)  
W1 (Heating Stage 1)  
W2 (Heating Stage 2)  
W3 (Heating Stage 3)  
Y1 (Cool Stage 1)  
W1  
W2  
W3  
Y1  
Y2  
Y2 (Cool Stage 2)  
Y3 (Cool Stage 3)  
Y3  
Y4 (Cool Stage 4)  
Y4  
SPACE SENSOR  
RESET  
20K ADJUST  
POTENTIOMETER  
COM SET  
SPACE  
SENSOR  
10K TYPE III  
THERMISTOR  
SUPPLY AIR  
TEMP RESET  
0-10 VDC  
Use Shielded  
Wire  
GND  
CO2 SENSOR  
(Field Supplied)  
0-2000 PPM  
(Field Supplied)  
SSO  
COM  
TMP  
DV+  
REM -  
Use  
Shielded  
Wire  
0-10 VDC OUTPUT  
Shutdown  
Use Shielded Wire  
ST  
REM +  
DV-  
R
SD1  
R
OCC  
VAV HEAT RELAY  
PURGE  
VAV OPEN +  
24 VDC  
RELAY  
(Field Supplied)  
BAS ECONOMIZER  
INPUT  
BAS ECON +  
VAV OPEN -  
0-10 VDC  
(Field Supplied)  
BAS ECON -  
Use shielded wire  
LD13002  
FIG. 2-8 – FIELD CONTROL WIRING CONNECTIONS  
36  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
POWER WIRING  
POWER WIRING  
The following calculations apply to electrical data for  
the rooftop unit. All concurrent load conditions must  
be considered in the calculations, and you must use the  
highest value for any combination of loads.  
Field wiring to the unit must conform to provisions  
of National Electrical Code (NEC) ANSI / NFPA 70-  
Latest Edition and / or local ordinances. The unit must  
be electrically grounded in accordance with the NEC  
and / or local codes. Voltage tolerances, which must be  
maintained during starting and running conditions, are  
indicated on the unit data plate.  
2
Minimum CircuitAmpacity (MCA) is based on 125%  
of the rated load amps for the largest motor plus 100%  
of the rated load amps for all other loads included in the  
circuit, per N.E.C. Article 440-34.  
The internal wiring harnesses furnished with this unit  
are an integral part of the design certified unit. Field  
alteration to comply with electrical codes should not  
be required. If any of the wire supplied with the unit  
must be replaced, replacement wire must be of the type  
shown on the wiring diagram and the same minimum  
gauge as the replaced wire.  
The minimum recommended disconnect switch is based  
on 115% of the rated load amps for all loads included  
in the circuit, per N.E.C.  
Maximum overcurrent protection is based upon 225%  
of the rated load amps for the largest motor plus 100%  
of the rated load amps for all other loads included in  
the circuit, per N.E.C. Article 440-22. If the maximum  
overcurrent protection does not equal a standard current  
rating of an overcurrent protective device, then the  
marked maximum rating is to be the next lower standard  
rating. However, if the device selected for maximum  
overcurrent protection is less than the MCA, then select  
the lowest standard maximum fuse size greater than or  
equal to the MCA.  
Power supply to the unit must be NEC Class 1 and must  
comply with all applicable codes. A disconnect switch  
must be provided (factory option available). The switch  
must be separate from all other circuits. Wire entry at  
knockout openings requires conduit fittings to comply  
with NEC and/or Local Codes.  
Refer to Figures 2-9, 2-10 & 2-11 for typical field wiring  
andtotheappropriateunitwiringdiagrammountedinside  
control doors for control circuit and power wiring  
information.  
Figures 2-9, 2-10 & 2-11 show the power wiring that  
must be field supplied and installed. See Table 2-16 for  
the allowable conductor wire size for the electrical lugs  
in the unit.  
ELECTRICAL SERVICE SIZING  
Electrical service required for the cooling only eco2  
rooftop, use the appropriate calculations listed below  
from U.L. 1995. Based on the operating mode and  
configuration of the rooftop, the calculations will  
yield different MCA (minimum circuit ampacity), and  
MOP (maximum overcurrent protection). MCA and  
Overcurrent Protection Device Data is supplied on  
the unit data plate. Also refer to Table 2-7, 2-9, 2-10,  
2-11, 2-12, 2-13 and 2-14, Electrical Data.  
For dual point power connections, TB1 in the power  
panel supplies the all unit compressors and condenser  
fans. TB2 in the power panel supplies power to the unit  
supply, return and exhaust fans, and control circuitry.  
All wiring must conform to the Na-  
tional Electrical Code (NEC) and  
local codes that may be in addition to  
NEC.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
37  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING  
1L1 1L2  
1L3  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 3  
LD13003  
Field Power  
Supply  
Earth  
Ground  
NOTES:  
1. All field wiring must be provided through a field-supplied fused disconnect switch to the unit terminals (or optional molded  
disconnect switch).  
2. All electrical wiring must be made in accordance with all N.E.C. and/or local code requirements.  
3. Minimum Circuit Ampacity (MCA) is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.14 (N.E.C. Section 440-34).  
4. Maximum Dual Element Fuse size is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.15 (N.E.C. Section 440-22).  
5. Use copper conductors only.  
FIG. 2-9 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
38  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING  
WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT SWITCH  
2
LD13004  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 3  
Field Power  
Supply  
Earth  
Ground  
NOTES:  
1. All field wiring must be provided through a field-supplied fused disconnect switch to the unit terminals (or optional molded  
disconnect switch).  
2. All electrical wiring must be made in accordance with all N.E.C. and/or local code requirements.  
3. Minimum Circuit Ampacity (MCA) is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.14 (N.E.C. Section 440-34).  
4. Maximum Dual Element Fuse size is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.15 (N.E.C. Section 440-22).  
5. Use copper conductors only.  
6. On units with an optional disconnect switch, the supplied disconnect switch is a “Disconnecting Means” as defined in the N.E.C. Section 100,  
and is intended for isolating the unit from the available power supply to perform maintenance and troubleshooting. This disconnect switch is  
not intended to be a Load Break Device.  
FIG. 2-10 – SINGLE-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING WITH NON-FUSED DISCONNECT  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
39  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING  
GND  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 3  
Field Power  
Supply #2  
Earth  
Ground  
LD13005  
Line 1  
Line 2  
Line 3  
Field Power  
Supply #1  
Earth  
Ground  
NOTES:  
1. All field wiring must be provided through a field-supplied fused disconnect switch to the unit terminals (or optional molded  
disconnect switch).  
2. All electrical wiring must be made in accordance with all N.E.C. and/or local code requirements.  
3. Minimum Circuit Ampacity (MCA) is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.14 (N.E.C. Section 440.34).  
4. Maximum Dual Element Fuse size is based on U.L. Standard 1995, Section 36.15 (N.E.C. Section 440.22).  
5. Use copper conductors only.  
FIG. 2-11 – DUAL-POINT POWER SUPPLY WIRING  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
40  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
CONTROLS  
2
TABLE 2-16 – THREE PHASE POWER SUPPLY CONDUCTOR SIZE RANGE  
050-061 Models  
Supply  
Voltage  
Single Point  
TB  
Single Point  
Disconnect  
Dual Point TB  
TB 1  
TB 2  
208V  
230V  
(2*) 250 kcmil-500 kcmil  
(2*) 250 kcmil-500 kcmil  
6 AWG-400 kcmil  
(2*) 2 AWG-500 kcmil  
(2*) 2 AWG-500 kcmil  
6 AWG-350 kcmil  
6 AWG-350 kcmil  
6 AWG-350 kcmil  
6 AWG-400 kcmil  
6 AWG-400 kcmil  
14 AWG-2/0  
6 AWG-350 kcmil  
6 AWG-350 kcmil  
14 AWG-2/0  
380V-60  
460V  
6 AWG-400 kcmil  
14 AWG-2/0  
14 AWG-2/0  
575V  
6 AWG-400 kcmil  
14 AWG-2/0  
14 AWG-2/0  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
41  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TRANSDUCER PNEUMATIC TUBING  
Static Pressure Control Plastic Tubing  
(Pneumatic Tubing)  
Duct static transducers (all VAV units) and any unit with  
an optional building pressure control transducer, require  
pneumatic tubing to be field supplied and installed.  
Both the duct static transducer (VAV only) and optional  
building pressure transducer are mounted behind the  
right hand damper door. All wiring from the transducers  
is factory installed.  
If the unit is equipped with both a building pressure  
transducer and a duct static transducer, a “tee” will  
be factory installed, and both the Duct Static Pressure  
Transducer and building pressure will be connected to  
the “tee” - both building static pressure transducer and  
duct static transducer will use the same factory supplied  
atmospheric pressure probe.  
Duct Static Transducer  
The “low” side connection of the  
duct static or building pressure trans-  
ducers are shipped with the pneumatic  
tubing factory installed and routed, to  
the external factory pressure tap.  
Plastic tubing (3/16" ID) must be run from the high  
pressure tap of the transducer to a static pressure tap  
(field supplied) in the supply duct, located at a point  
where constant pressure is desired. This is normally  
2/3rds of the way down the duct, before the first take  
off.  
Building Pressure Transducer  
Plastic tubing (3/16” ID) must be run from the high  
pressure tap of the building static pressure transducer  
to a static pressure tap (field supplied), located in the  
conditioned space. The tap should be placed in a  
location where over pressurization will cause a problem,  
for example, in the lobby area where excessive pressure  
will cause the doors to remain open. The tap should  
never be placed above the ceiling.  
Static Pressure Probe Installation  
On units with duct static transducers (VAV units) and  
any unit with an optional building pressure, a factory  
supplied Static Pressure Probe must be field installed at  
the top of the rear corner post on the unit - see Figure.  
2-12.  
The factory supplied atmospheric pressure probe and  
associated mounting hardware are shipped inside the  
unit control panel. The hardware consists of a mounting  
bracket and a short section of pneumatic tubing. The  
pneumatic tubing must be field installed from a factory  
pressure tap (next to the mounting location for the  
static pressure probe) to the atmospheric pressure  
probe (see Installation Instructions, Form XXX.XX-  
XX).  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
42  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
2
Filter  
Comparttmmeenntt  
EEccoonnoommiizzer  
CCoommppaarrtment  
LD13127  
FIG. 2-12 – ATMOSPHERIC SENSOR PROBE  
The atmospheric probe should be mounted on the support post on the control side  
of the unit between the Economizer and the Filter compartment.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
43  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
DUCT SYSTEM  
Installation of elbows, discharge  
damper and other abrupt flow area  
changes installed directly at the fan  
outlet will cause system losses. These  
losses must be taken into account  
during the design phase and must be  
added to any field measurements.  
Duct Connection Guidelines  
All intake and discharge air duct connection to the  
unit may be made directly to the unit. These air duct  
connections should be on flexible material and should  
be installed so they are sufficiently loose. Duct runs  
and transitions must be made carefully to hold friction  
loss to a minimum. Avoid short turns, and duct elbows  
should contain splitters or turning vanes.  
SOUND AND VIBRATION TRANSMISSION  
All roof mounted air handling units generate some  
sound and vibration, which may or may not require  
some special treatment of the air conditioned space. The  
noise generated by the air handling unit is dependent  
on the speed of the fan, the amount of air the fan is  
moving, the fan type and the static efficiency of the fan.  
In applications where sound and vibration transmissions  
may be objectionable, good acoustical engineering  
practices must be incorporated in the system design.  
Duct work connected to the fan discharge should run in a  
straight line for at least two equivalent outlet diameters.  
Never deadhead the discharge into the flat surface of  
a plenum.  
Refer to Table 2-17 and 2-18 for available supply and  
return duct connection configuration.  
TABLE 2-17 – SUPPLY AIR DUCT CONNECTION  
CONFIGURATIONS  
The eco2 unit is designed for lower sound levels than  
competitive units by using flexible fan connections,  
fan spring isolators, double-wall construction, multiple  
fan options, and lower speed and horsepower fans. For  
VAV applications, VFDs are used instead of inlet guide  
vanes. Additional sound attenuation can be obtained  
using compressor sound blankets and field-supplied  
sound attenuators when necessary.  
SUPPLY AIR  
UNIT CONFIGURATION  
BOTTOM LEFT RIGHT  
COOLING ONLY  
COOL/GAS HEAT 375-750  
MBH  
N/A  
N/A  
50-61 TONS  
COOL/GAS HEAT 1125 MBH  
N/A  
TABLE 2-18 – RETURN AIR DUCT CONNECTION  
CONFIGURATIONS  
Even with these equipment design features, the  
acoustical characteristics of the entire installation must  
never be overlooked.Additional steps for the acoustical  
characteristics of a rooftop installation should be  
addressed during the design phase of a project to avoid  
costly alterations after the installation of the equipment.  
During the design phase of a project, the designing  
engineer should consider, at a minimum, the impact of  
the equipment location, rooftop installation, building  
structure, and duct work.  
SUPPLY AIR  
UNIT CONFIGURATION  
BOTTOM LEFT RIGHT  
NO EXHAUST  
BAROMETRIC RELIEF  
DAMPER  
N/A  
50-61 TONS  
POWERED EXHAUST FAN  
RETURN FAN  
N/A  
N/A  
N/A  
Discharge  
RIGHT  
Return  
FRONT  
FRONT  
LEFT  
BOTTOM  
NOTE:  
This diagram is provided as a visual reference of the eco2 discharge & return air openings & locations for all sizes. Please refer to Fig 2-4 for exact  
size & location of panels and openings.  
LD08045  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
44  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
GAS HEATING  
GAS PIPING  
UNIT BASERAIL  
FACTORY  
PIPING  
Proper sizing of the gas piping depends on the cubic feet  
per hour of gas flow required, specific gravity of the gas  
and the length of run. National Fuel Gas Code Z223.1  
– latest Edition should be followed in all cases unless  
superseded by local codes or gas company requirements.  
Refer to Table 2-19.  
UNION (For Servicing)  
1/8" NPT PLUG  
MANUAL GAS  
VALVE  
1-1/2" FPT  
ROOF  
CURB  
PITCH POCKET  
2
DRIP LEG  
The heating value of the gas may differ with locality.  
The value should be checked with the local gas utility.  
LD11765A  
ROOF  
FIG. 2-13 – TYPICAL GAS PIPING CONNECTION  
TABLE 2-19 – PIPE SIZES  
NOMINAL IRON PIPE SIZE  
LENGTH IN  
Gas Piping Recommendations  
1-1/2 IN.1  
2 IN.1  
3,050  
2,100  
1,650  
1,450  
1,270  
1,150  
1,050  
990  
FEET  
10  
20  
30  
40  
50  
60  
70  
80  
1,600  
1,100  
890  
1. A drip leg and a ground joint union must be in-  
stalled in the gas piping.  
2. When required by local codes, a manual shut-off  
valve will have to be installed outside of the unit.  
3. Use wrought iron or steel pipe for all gas lines. Pipe  
dope should be applied sparingly to male threads  
only.  
760  
1
Maximum capacity of pipe in cubic feet of gas per  
Natural gas may contain some pro-  
pane. Propane being an excellent  
solvent will quickly dissolve white  
lead or most standard commercial  
compounds. Therefore, a special pipe  
dope must be applied when wrought  
iron or steel pipe is used. Shellac  
base components such as Gaskolac  
or Stalastic, and compounds such as  
Rectorseal #5, Clyde’s or John Crane  
may be used.  
hour (based upon a pressure drop of 0.3 inch water  
column and 0.6 specific gravity gas).  
There may be a local gas utility re-  
quirement specifying a minimum  
diameter for gas piping. All units re-  
quire a 1-1/2-inch pipe connection at  
the entrance fitting. Line size should  
not be sized smaller then the entrance  
fitting size.  
GAS CONNECTION  
4. All piping should be cleaned of dirt and scale by  
hammering on the outside of the pipe and blow-  
ing out the loose particles. Before initial start-up,  
be sure that all of the gas lines external to the unit  
have been purged of air.  
5. The gas supply should be a separate line and in-  
stalled in accordance with all safety codes as pre-  
scribed under “Limitations” listed in the beginning  
of this section. After the gas connections have been  
completed, open the main shutoff valve admitting  
gas pressure to the mains. Check all joints for  
leaks with soap solution or other material suitable  
for the purpose. NEVER USE A FLAME!  
The gas supply line should be routed within the space  
and penetrate the roof at the gas inlet connection of  
the unit. The gas piping can enter the unit through an  
opening in the base of the gas heat section. Many local  
codes require that a shut off valve be located external to  
the unit. In these cases it is easier to run the gas piping  
on the roof and enter the unit through the side of the  
base rail. Typical supply piping arrangements are shown  
in Figure 2-13.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
45  
Installation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
6. The furnace and its individual manual shut-off  
valve must be disconnected from the gas supply  
piping system during any pressure testing of that  
system at test pressures in excess of 0.5 PSIG.  
Disconnect gas piping from unit when  
leak testing at pressures greater than  
0.5 PSIG. Pressures greater than 0.5  
PSIG will cause gas valve damage  
resulting in a hazardous condition.  
If gas valve is subjected to pressure  
greater than 0.5 PSIG, it must be  
replaced.  
7. A 1/8 inch N.P.T plugged tapping, accessible for  
test gage connection, must be installed immedi-  
ately upstream of the gas supply connection to the  
furnace.  
COMBUSTION VENT  
The combustion vent assembly is shipped in the return  
air section of the unit. The combustion vent assembly  
must be mounted over the flue gas outlet fixed panel  
located to the right of the gas heat access door. Install  
as follows:  
1. Remove the combustion vent assembly from the  
return compartment.  
2. Remove the vertical row of six screws on either  
side of the flue gas outlet fixed panel.  
3. Mount the combustion vent assembly over the flue  
gas outlets and attach to the gas outlet fixed panel  
using the screws removed in step 2.  
4. See Figure 2-14 for the proper orientation of the  
combustion vent. The internal baffle(s) must direct  
the flue gases upward.  
LD11766  
FIG. 2-14 – COMBUSTION VENT  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
46  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 3 – START-UP  
CHECKING THE SYSTEM PRIOR TO INITIAL START  
(NO POWER)  
To protect warranty, this equipment  
must be installed and serviced by an  
authorized JOHNSON CONTROLS  
service mechanic or a qualified service  
person experienced in air handling  
and condenser unit installation.  
Installation must comply with all ap-  
plicable codes, particularly in regard  
to electrical wiring and other safety  
elements such as relief valves, HP  
cut-out settings, design working pres-  
sures and ventilation requirements  
consistent with the amount and type  
of refrigerant charge.  
Unit Checks  
1.Inspect the unit for shipping or installation dam-  
age.  
2.Visually check for refrigerant piping leaks.  
3.The compressor oil level should be maintained so  
that an oil level is visible in the sight glass. The  
oil level can only be tested when the compressor is  
running in stabilized conditions, guaranteeing that  
there is no liquid refrigerant in the lower shell of the  
compressor. In this case, the oil must be between  
1/4 and 3/4 in the sight glass. At shutdown, the oil  
level can fall to the bottom limit of the oil sight  
glass.  
3
Lethal voltages exist within the Con-  
trol Panel. Before servicing, open and  
tag all disconnect switches.  
4.Check the control panel to assure it is free of for-  
eign material (wires, metal chips, etc.).  
5.Visually inspect field wiring (power and control).  
Wiring MUST meet N.E.C. and local codes.  
6.Check tightness of terminal lugs inside the power  
panel on both sides of the contactors, overloads,  
fuses, and power connections.  
Reference publication Form 100.50-  
SU1 (507) “Quick Startup Guide” for  
additional information.  
CRANKCASE HEATERS  
7.Verify fuse sizing in main circuits.  
8.Verify field wiring for thermostat (if applicable),  
optional zone sensor, etc.  
9.Verify all applicable pneumatic tubing has been  
field installed for Duct Static Pressure Transducers  
(VAV units), optional building pressure transducer  
for power exhaust option, and outdoor static pres-  
sure prove.  
With power applied to the rooftop unit, the crankcase  
heater for each compressor will be ON whenever the  
compressor is not running. The heater is interlocked into  
the compressor motor contactor and is not controlled  
by the microprocessor.  
The purpose of the crankcase heater is to prevent  
the migration of refrigerant to the crankcase during  
shutdown, assuring proper lubrication of the compressor  
on start-up.  
10. Supply exhaust and return fan isolators spring bolts  
are removed (refer to Figure 3-1).  
11. Verify proper bearing and locking collar torque  
values on supply and exhaust fans (refer to Main-  
tenance section of manual).  
12. Verify proper drive alignment of supply and ex-  
haust fans (refer to Maintenance section of man-  
ual).  
Anytime power is removed from the unit for more than  
an hour, the crankcase heater should be left on for 24  
hours prior to start.  
Power must be applied to the rooftop  
unit 24 hours prior to starting the unit  
compressors. Failure to observe this  
requirement can lead to compressor  
damage and voiding of the compressor  
warranty.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
47  
Startup  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
13. Verify proper belt tension of supply fan, exhaust  
fan or return fan (refer to Maintenance section of  
manual). Belts must be checked after 24 hours of  
initial operation.  
The supply, exhaust and return fans  
have tie down bolts are installed at the  
factory to prevent movement in the fan  
assemblies during shipment. THESE  
HOLD DOWN BOLTS MUST BE  
REMOVEDPRIORTOOPERATION  
OF THE ABOVE FANS. There are  
eight bolts per assembly two at each  
comer of the fan skids, front and rear.  
The bolt locations are shown in Figure  
3-1. The bolt heads are red in color  
and a label identifies their location in  
the unit.  
14. Manually rotate condenser fan blades, supply  
exhaust and return blower wheels and motors, to  
assure freedom of movement.  
15. Verify proper condensate drain trap installation  
(refer to Figure 2-6). Fill traps with water prior to  
unit start-up.  
16. If applicable, verify installation of air filters (refer  
to Installation section for size and quantity).  
Fan Hold  
EXHAUST FAN ASSEMBLY  
Brackets  
LD13268  
Fan Hold Down Brackets (4)  
SUPPLY FAN ASSEMBLY  
FIG. 3-1 – FAN HOLD DOWN BRACKETS  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
48  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
17. Verify Variable Frequency Drive setpoints for VAV  
unit Supply Fan and optional Variable Frequency  
Drive Exhaust and/or Return Fan drives. The Sup-  
ply Fan VFD is located to the right of the electrical  
control box in the supply fan blower compartment.  
Refer to separate manual for VFD operation sup-  
plied with the unit.  
18. If equipped, open suction line ball valve, discharge  
line ball valve, and liquid line ball valve for each  
refrigerant system.  
The eco2 rooftop unit uses hermetic scroll compressors,  
which only pump in one direction. Therefore, it is  
necessary to verify proper rotation at unit start-up.  
Operation of the compressor in the reverse direction  
will not pump, and cause the compressor to cycle on  
internal overload. Operating the compressor in reverse  
for “extended” periods can result in failure of the  
compressor.  
To verify proper rotation, monitor the suction and  
discharge pressures of the respective refrigerant  
circuit when the compressor cycles on. If the discharge  
pressure increases and suction pressure decreases as the  
compressor cycles on, the compressor is properly phased  
and operating in the correct rotation.  
UNIT CHECKS – POWER APPLIED  
1.Apply 3-phase power and verify its value. Volt-  
age imbalance should be no more than 2% of the  
average voltage.  
2.Verify programmed units Setpoints (refer to “Quick  
Compressor Oil Level Check  
3
Start-Up Guide”, Form 100.50-SU3).  
The oil level can only be tested when the compressor is  
running in stabilized conditions, to ensure that there is  
no liquid refrigerant in the lower shell of the compressor.  
When the compressor is running in stabilized conditions,  
the oil level must be between 1/2 and 3/4 in the oil sight  
glass. Note: at shutdown, the oil level can fall to the  
bottom limit of the oil sight glass.  
3.Verify correct fan rotation – fan should rotate in  
direction of arrow on fan housing.  
4.Insure proper compressor rotation - see following  
instruction on Verifying Compressor Rotation.  
Verifying Compressor Rotation  
This unit uses scroll compressors,  
which will only operate in one di-  
rection. Failure to observe these steps  
could lead to compressor failure.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
49  
Startup  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
INITIAL START-UP  
Checking Superheat and Subcooling  
An R-410A temperature and pressure chart lists the  
associated saturation temperature in one column, with  
the associated pressure in another column. As a result,  
only one temperature/pressure column is needed to show  
the relationship.  
After all of the preceding checks have been completed  
and the control panel has been programmed as required,  
the unit may be placed into operation.  
1.Place the Unit Switch in the control panel to the  
ON position.  
2.With a demand, the supply fan will cycle on, and  
permit compressor operation if the air proving  
pressure switch for the supply fan has closed.  
3.The first compressor will start. After several  
minutes of operation, a flow of refrigerant will  
be noted in the sight glass, the vapor in the sight  
glass will clear, and there should be a solid column  
of liquid visible in the sightglass when the TXV  
stabilizes.  
Subcooling (R-410A)  
When the refrigerant charge is correct, there will be no  
vapor in the liquid sight glass with the system operating  
under full load conditions.  
The subcooling temperature of each system can be  
calculated by recording the temperature of the liquid  
line at the outlet of the condenser and subtracting it  
from the saturation temperature listed in Table 3-1, for  
the corresponding discharge pressure. If the rooftop unit  
does not have an access port for liquid access, subtract  
the condenser coil pressure drop value from the table  
on this page from the discharge pressure to determine  
the equivalent saturation temperature.  
4.Allow the compressor to run a short time, being  
ready to stop it immediately if any unusual noise  
or adverse conditions develop.  
5.Check the system operating parameters by checking  
evaporator superheat and condensing subcooling.  
Connect a gauge manifold set to the Schrader ser-  
vice valve connections on the liquid and common  
suction line in the condensing section of the unit.  
After the system is running and the pressures have  
stabilized, measure the temperature at the liquid  
and common suction lines near the Schrader ser-  
vice valves. Calculate evaporator superheat and  
condensing subcooling. The subcooling, should be  
approximately 15.0 ˚F and the superheat should be  
12.0 ˚F. Repeat the above process for each of the  
refrigerant systems.  
Example:  
On a YPAL 050 the discharge pressure is 388 PSIG  
and the  
liquid temperature is 95 °F  
Liquid Pressure = Discharge Pressure (388 PSIG)  
- 33.0 PSIG  
Saturation Temperature for 355 PSIG = 108°F  
Minus the liquid line temp  
Liquid Line Subcooling of  
= 95°F  
= 13°F  
6.With an ammeter, verify that each phase of the con-  
denser fans, compressors, supply fan, and exhaust  
fan are within the RLA/FLA as listed on the unit  
data plate.  
The subcooling should be 15°F at design conditions.  
Superheat (R-410A)  
The superheat should be checked only after steady  
state operation of the unit has been established, the  
discharge air temperature has been pulled down to  
within the control range, and the unit is running in a  
fully loaded condition.  
Refrigerant Charge  
This rooftop unit comes fully charged from the factory  
with refrigerant R-410A as standard.  
CONDENSER COIL PRESSURE DROP  
YPAL050  
33 PSIG  
YPAL051  
39 PSIG  
YPAL060  
24 PSIG  
YPAL061  
27 PSIG  
The superheat is calculated as the difference between the  
actual temperature of the refrigerant gas in the suction  
line and the temperature corresponding to the Suction  
Pressure as shown in Table 3-1.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
50  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Leak Checking  
Example:  
Leak check compressors, fittings and piping to assure  
no leaks. Verify the evaporator distributor tubes do not  
have bare copper touching each other or are against a  
sheet metal edge. If you are leak checking a unit charged  
with R-410A make sure the leak test device is capable  
of sensing refrigerant R-410A.  
The suction pressure is 130 PSIG and the  
suction line temperature is 57 °F  
Suction Line Temperature  
= 57°F  
Saturation Temperature for 130 PSIG = 45°F  
Evaporator Superheat  
= 12°F  
When adjusting the expansion valve, the adjusting  
screw should be turned not more than one turn at a time,  
allowing sufficient time (approximately 15 minutes)  
between adjustments for the system and the thermal  
expansion valve to respond and stabilize.  
If the unit is functioning satisfactorily during the  
initial operating period, no safeties trip and the unit  
controls are functioning properly, the rooftop unit is  
ready to be placed into operation.  
The superheat setting should be adjusted to 12°F at  
design conditions.  
3
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
51  
Startup  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 3-1 –R410-A PRESSURE / TEMPERATURE CHART  
PSIG  
0
TEMP ˚F  
-60  
-58  
-54  
-50  
-46  
-42  
-39  
-36  
-33  
-30  
-28  
-26  
-24  
-20  
-18  
-16  
-14  
-12  
-10  
-8  
PSIG  
78  
TEMP ˚F  
20  
21  
24  
26  
29  
32  
34  
36  
39  
41  
43  
45  
47  
49  
51  
53  
57  
60  
64  
67  
70  
73  
76  
78  
80  
83  
85  
88  
90  
92  
95  
97  
101  
108  
112  
118  
134  
149  
159  
2
80  
4
85  
6
90  
8
95  
10  
12  
14  
16  
18  
20  
22  
24  
26  
28  
30  
32  
34  
36  
38  
40  
42  
44  
46  
48  
50  
52  
54  
56  
58  
60  
62  
64  
66  
68  
70  
72  
74  
76  
100  
105  
110  
115  
120  
125  
130  
135  
140  
145  
150  
160  
170  
180  
190  
200  
210  
220  
225  
235  
245  
255  
265  
275  
285  
295  
305  
325  
355  
375  
405  
500  
600  
700  
-6  
-4  
-3  
-2  
0
1
3
4
6
7
8
10  
11  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
19  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
52  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
GAS HEAT MODELS  
Pre-Start Checks:  
When starting up these units, it is imperative  
that ALL gas fittings within the unit (in addition  
to the field installed gas connections) are leak  
checked with a soap solution as part of the unit  
commissioning process. The heat section must  
be fired when checking the joints on the manifold  
side of the gas valve. If any leaks are detected,  
the leaks must be repaired immediately and all  
joints rechecked.  
The heat section has two roll out switches mount-  
ed above the burners. The purpose of the roll  
out switch is to protect the gas heat section from  
flame roll out, flame burning outside the heat  
exchanger. A restriction in the heat exchanger  
or breach in the flue passages could result in a  
roll out situation. The roll out switch is a manual  
reset device.  
The unit has two high temperature limit switches.  
One located at the heat exchanger vestibule panel  
and the other located in the area of the heat ex-  
changer return bend. These limits are automatic  
reset devices. If the limit opens the ignition  
control will de-energize the gas valve. On staged  
gas heat, as soon as the limit closes the ignition  
control will reinitiate the ignition sequence. If the  
limit opens on a modulating gas heat section the  
Unit Controller will lockout the heat section.  
Verify wiring inside the burner compartment to  
insure the wiring/terminals are tight and securely  
connected to the components, such as the ignition  
control, flame sensor, gas valve, rollout switches  
and igniter.  
3
The gas heat start up sequence begins with a 30  
second prepurge. The next step in the sequence  
is the closure of the air proving switch. The heat  
section has a combustion air-proving switch.  
This switch must close before the ignition se-  
quence can initiate. If the air-proving switch is  
closed after the 30 second prepurge the ignition  
control will energize the spark igniter and open  
the gas valve.  
The control circuit is tested in the factory to insure  
that all of these steps are followed, however, natu-  
ral gas is not actually introduced to the system in  
the plant; nitrogen is used in its place.  
Post Start Checks:  
The furnace ignition control uses flame rectifi-  
cation as verification of burner operation. The  
minimum allowable flame current for operation  
is 0.7 dc microamps.  
When a signal is received at the gas heat control mod-  
ule from the Unit Controller, verify:  
Combustion blower starts and runs for 30 seconds  
before the spark is initiated.  
Spark igniter sparks.  
Gas valve opens.  
Burners light from right to left, in a 2.5 second  
time frame; that each one lights in sequential order  
from right to left; and establishes stable flame im-  
mediately upon ignition.  
If the furnace ignition control does not prove  
flame in 7 seconds, it will turn off the spark signal  
and close the gas valve. It will wait 30 seconds  
and then initiate a second ignition sequence. If  
flame is not proven during the second 7 second  
trial for ignition the control will turn off the spark  
signal, close the gas valve, wait 30 seconds and  
initiate a third ignition sequence. If flame recti-  
fication is not proven on the third try, the ignition  
control will lock out.  
Check for gas leaks in the unit piping as well as  
the supply piping.  
Check for correct manifold gas pressures. See  
“Manifold Gas Pressure Adjustment” in this Sec-  
tion.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
53  
Startup  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Manifold Gas Pressure Adjustment  
Check the supply pressure. It must be within the  
limitations shown in Table 3-2. Supply pressure  
should be checked with all gas appliances in the  
building at full fire. At no time should the standby  
gas pressure exceed 13.5" WC, nor the operating  
pressure drop below 4.5" WC for natural gas or  
11.0" WC for propane. If the gas pressure is out-  
side these limits, contact the installing mechanical  
contractor for corrective action.  
Small adjustments to the manifold gas pressure  
can be made by following the procedure outlined  
below. Refer to Figure 3-2 for the high and low  
fire pressure regulator adjustment locations.  
Turn the gas off to the unit.  
Use a 3/16 inch Allen wrench to remove the 1/8  
inch NPT plug from the outlet pressure tap of the  
valve.  
The flame is stable, with flame present only at the  
end of the burner, no burning is occurring inside  
the burner. There should be little yellow tipping  
of the flame.  
Install a brass adapter to allow the connection of  
a hose to the outlet pressure tap of the valve.  
Connect the hose to a manometer capable of read-  
ing the required manifold pressure value.  
There may be some smoke thru the flue, due to  
tooling oil burning off of the heat exchanger tub-  
ing.  
Turn the gas back on.  
Place the heat section into high fire operation.  
Compare the high fire manifold pressure to Table  
TABLE 3-2 – LOW FIRE / HIGH FIRE PRESSURES  
3-2.  
LINE PRESSURE  
MANIFOLD PRESSURE  
LOW FIRE HIGH FIRE  
+/- 0.3 “WC +/- 0.3 “WC  
TYPE OF  
GAS  
To adjust the high fire manifold pressure remove  
the cap from the high fire pressure regulator. Use  
a 3/32Allen wrench to make the manifold pressure  
adjustment. To increase the manifold pressure,  
turn the screw clockwise; to decrease the manifold  
pressure, turn the screw counterclockwise. Place  
your finger over the adjustment opening while  
verifying the manifold pressure.  
MINIMUM MAXIMUM  
NATURAL  
4.5 “WC  
13.5 “WC  
13.5 “WC  
1.2 “WC  
4.2 “WC  
3.5 “WC  
10.0”WC  
PROPANE 11.0 “WC  
HIGH FIRE PRESSURE  
REGULATOR  
Place the heat section into low fire operation.  
REGULATOR VENT COVER  
Compare the low fire manifold pressure to Table  
3-2.  
To adjust the low fire manifold pressure remove  
the cap from the low fire pressure regulator. Use  
a 3/32 inch Allen wrench to make the manifold  
pressure adjustment. To increase the manifold  
pressure, turn the screw clockwise; to decrease  
the manifold pressure, turn the screw counter-  
clockwise. Place your finger over the adjustment  
opening while verifying the manifold pressure.  
LOW FIRE  
PRESSURE  
REGULATOR  
TWO STAGE  
PRESSURE  
REGULATOR  
Turn the heat off.  
INLET  
LD11760a  
Turn the gas off.  
FIG. 3-2 – MANIFOLD GAS PRESSURE  
ADJUSTMENT  
Remove the brass tubing adapter and replace the  
plug in the outlet pressure tap.  
TABLE 3-3 – GAS HEAT PERFORMANCE DATA  
GAS INPUT CAPACITY MAXIMUM OUTPUT CAPACITY  
AIRFLOW  
MIN.  
7,500  
14,000  
21,000  
TEMP. RISE  
(°F)  
UNIT  
(BTU/HR X 1000)  
(BTU/HR X 1000)  
MAX.  
24,000  
24,000  
24,000  
375  
750  
300  
600  
900  
40  
40  
40  
50-61  
1125  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
54  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 4 – MAINTENANCE  
Oil Analysis: Use York Type “T” POE oil (clear) for  
units charged with R-410A refrigerant. The type of  
refrigerant and amount per system is listed on the unit  
rating plate. A change in the oil color or odor may  
be an indication of contaminates in the refrigeration  
system. If this occurs, an oil sample should be taken  
and analyzed. If contaminations are present, the system  
must be cleaned to prevent compressor failure. This can  
be accomplished through the installation of oversized  
suction and liquid line driers. The driers may have to be  
changed several times to clean up the system depending  
on the degree of contamination.  
Make sure power is removed from  
the unit before performing the main-  
tenance items contained in this sec-  
tion.  
GENERAL  
Aplanned program of regularly scheduled maintenance  
will return dividends by averting possible costly and  
unexpected periods of down time. It is the responsibility  
of the owner to provide the necessary maintenance  
for the air handling units and coils. If a system failure  
occurs due to improper maintenance during the warranty  
period, JOHNSON CONTROLS will not be liable  
for costs incurred to return the unit to satisfactory  
operation.  
Never use the scroll compressor  
to pump the refrigerant system down  
into a vacuum. Doing so will cause  
internal arcing of the compressor  
motor, which will result in failure of  
compressor.  
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – MONTHLY  
Fan Bearing Lubrication  
4
Filters  
Add grease slowly with shaft rotating until a slight  
bead forms at the seals. If necessary, re-lubricate while  
bearing is stationary. The fan data plate (attached to  
the fan scroll) lists the type of grease that must be used  
for lubricating the bearings. Refer to Table 4-1 for  
lubricating schedule.  
Check the cleanliness of the filters and replace or clean  
as required.  
Linkages  
Examine the damper and operator linkages to insure  
that each is free and operating smoothly.  
Re-lubrication is generally accompanied by a temporary  
rise in operating temperature. Excess grease will be  
purged at seals.  
Compressors  
Oil Level Check: The oil level can only be tested when  
the compressor is running in stabilized conditions, to  
ensure that there is no liquid refrigerant in the lower  
shell of the compressor. When the compressor is running  
in stabilized conditions, the oil level must be between  
1/4 and 3/4 in the oil sight glass. Note: at shutdown,  
the oil level can fall to the bottom limit of the oil sight  
glass.  
Recommended Lubricant for Fan Bearings  
A Lithium / Petroleum base grease conforming to an  
NLGI Grade II consistency is normally used. Lubricant  
must be free of any chemical impurities such as free  
acid or free alkali, dust, rust, metal particles or abrasive.  
This light viscosity, low torque grease is rust inhibited  
and water resistant, has a temperature range of -30°F  
to +200°F with intermittent highs of +250°F. Lubricate  
bearings as required by the severity of required duty.  
TABLE 4-1 – FAN BEARING – LUBRICATION INTERVALS  
RELUBRICATION SCHEDULE (MONTHS) BALL BEARING PILLOW BLOCKS  
SPEED (RPM)  
500 1000 1500 2000 2500 3000 3500  
4000  
4500  
SHAFT DIA  
1/2” thru 1-11/16”  
1-15/16” thru 2-7/16”  
2-11/16” thru 2-15/16”  
3-7/16” thru 3-15/16”  
6
6
5
3
3
2
2
2
1
6
5
4
5
4
3
4
3
2
2
2
1
2
1
1
1/2  
1/2  
1/4  
1/4  
1/2  
1/2  
1/2  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
55  
Maintenance  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – YEARLY  
Condenser Coils  
Dirt should not be allowed to accumulate on the  
condenser coil surfaces. Cleaning should be as often  
as necessary to keep coil clean.  
Check the fan wheels and inspect the drain pan for  
sludge and foreign material. Clean if required.  
Observe the operation of all dampers and make any  
necessary adjustments in linkage and blade orientation  
for proper operation.  
PERIODIC MAINTENANCE – THREE TO SIX MONTHS  
Disconnect and lock-out power from  
the unit anytime service is being per-  
formed on the fan section. Failure to  
do so could result in serious injury or  
death due to the fan turning on while  
work is in progress.  
Entire Unit Inspection  
In addition to the checks listed in this section, periodic  
overall inspections of the unit should be accomplished  
to ensure proper equipment operation. Items such as  
loose hardware, component operation, refrigerant leaks,  
unusual noises, etc. should be investigated and corrected  
immediately.  
Squealing belts during starting is  
caused by slipping belts that are not  
tensioned properly.  
Sheave Alignment:  
To check sheave alignment, a straight edge or a piece of  
string can be used. If the sheaves are properly aligned,  
the string or straight edge will touch at all points, as  
indicated in Figure. 4-1. Rotating the sheaves will  
determine if the sheave is wobbly or the drive shaft is  
bent.Alignment error must be corrected to avoid bearing  
and belt failure.  
Motor Bearing Lubrication  
Bearings must be re-lubricated periodically to assure  
long life. Motor bearing should be lubricated yearly,  
but may need lubrication more frequently, depending  
on severe operating conditions.  
CORD TIED  
TO SHAFT  
Belt Tension  
Adjust the belt tension if necessary. Required belt  
tension data is supplied on the fan “skid” data plate,  
attached to the fan housing. Never use a belt dressing  
on the belts. If belts slip with the proper tension, use a  
good grade of belt cleanser to clean the belts. Refer to  
Figures 4-1.  
CORD TOUCHING SHEAVES AT  
POINTS INDICATED BY ARROWS  
LD07634  
FIG. 4-1 – SHEAVE ALIGNMENT  
Belts  
Never use excessive belt tension,  
as this could result in damaging  
the bearing, motor pulleys or motor  
base. See drive label on fan housing  
adjacent to drive for specific details  
on tension.  
New belts should be re-checked after 24 hours of  
operation. On multiple belt adjustable pulleys, the pitch  
depth should be checked to insure identical belt travel,  
power transfer and wear. Adjustable motor bases are  
provided for belt adjustment.  
Motor pulleys and blower shaft pulleys are locked  
in position with either set screws or split taper lock  
bushings. All set screws and/or taper lock bolts must  
be checked for tightness and alignment before putting  
equipment into operation.  
When it is necessary to replace one belt in a given set,  
the entire set of belts must be replaced.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
56  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
An incorrectly aligned and tensioned belt can  
substantially shorten belt life or overload blower and  
motor bearings, shortening their life expectancy. A belt  
tensioned too tightly can overload the motor electrical,  
causing nuisance tripping of the motor overloads and/or  
motor failure and/or shaft failure.  
Belt Replacement  
Always replace belts as a set. Follow the steps below  
to replace belts:  
1.Release the tension on the belts by loosening the  
adjusting nuts on the fan motor.  
2.Remove old belts and recheck the sheave alignment  
with a straight edge.  
3.Install the new belts on the sheaves.  
LD06354  
FIG. 4-3 – BELT TENSIONING GAUGE  
Belt Tensioning:  
Never place the belts on the sheaves by using a  
screwdriver to pry the belt over the rim of the sheave.  
This will permanently damage the belts.  
Belt tension information is included on the fan skid data  
plate as shown in Figure. 4-2. Sample data plate shows  
4.3 lbs pressure at .30 inches deflection.  
A Browning Belt tension gauge is used in Figure. 4-3  
to properly tension belts.  
4
FIG. 4-2 – FAN DATA PLATE - BELT TENSION00494vip  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
57  
Maintenance  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Filter Drier Replacement  
The filter/drier should be replaced any time work is  
performed on the refrigerant circuit. The rooftop unit  
comes with sealed type (non-replaceable) cores as  
standard. If the unit is not equipped with the optional  
valve package (suction, discharge, & liquid line valves),  
the refrigerant will need to be recovered with a recovery  
machine to replace the filter/drier.  
If the unit is equipped with a valve package, the unit  
can be pumped down by closing the liquid line ball  
valve (prior to the filter/drier) while the unit is running,  
initiating a unit pump-down. The unit will shut off when  
the mechanical low-pressure switch opens. When the  
unit shuts down, close the ball valve located after the  
filter/drier and remove power from the unit to prevent  
the unit from running. Once the filter/drier core has been  
replaced, the filter/drier section should be evacuated via  
the Schrader access valve located next to the filter/drier  
prior to opening the ball valves and restoring the unit  
to normal operation.  
LD06355  
FIG. 4-4 – EXAMPLE OF FC FAN SHAFT/WHEEL  
MARKING  
4.Loosen and remove set screws on both bearing  
locking collars. Inspect and, if necessary, re-  
place.  
5.Loosen and remove set screws from both sides of  
the wheel hub. Inspect and, if necessary, replace.  
Never shut the discharge valve while  
the unit is running. Doing so could  
cause a rupture in the discharge line  
or components, resulting in death or  
serious injury.  
6.Using a rubber mallet or brass bar, slowly drive  
the shaft in one direction until the set screw marks  
on the shaft are fully exposed. File the marks  
completely smooth. Drive the shaft in the opposite  
direction and file smooth the set screw marks. Con-  
tinue to clean the shaft of all dirt and residuals.  
7.To remove the key, use a rubber mallet or brass bar  
to drive the shaft and wheel in one direction. Drive  
the key in the opposite direction using a nail set or  
smaller size key stock until the key is completely  
free of the wheel. Be sure that key does not get  
bent by allowing it to ride up the key way edge.  
The slightest bend will prevent quick assembly.  
Should this occur, replace the key stock.  
8.Remove the shaft, supporting the weight of the  
wheel, particularly for larger diameter wheels. Do  
not allow the weight of the shaft to be supported  
by one bearing as you disassemble.  
9.Remove the wheel through the discharge or outlet  
area of the blower housing.  
Never close the suction line ball valve  
with the compressor running. Doing  
so will cause the compressor to pump-  
down into a vacuum and damage the  
compressor due to internal arcing.  
Forward Curved Fans  
The forward curved fan wheel must be removed through  
the fan discharge opening. The location of other clamps,  
fan wheel, and shaft must be marked so each of these  
components can be reassembled in the same location  
- see Figure 4-4. This will preserve the balance of the  
rotating assembly. Proceed with the following steps:  
1.Disconnect all duct work or guards attached to the  
blower housing to permit unobstructed access.  
2.Remove the cut off plate attached at the discharge  
or blast area of the blower housing.  
3.Thoroughly clean the shaft of all grease and rust  
inhibitor. Be careful not to contaminate the bearing  
grease. Use emery cloth to remove all rust or the  
wheel may become “locked” to the shaft.  
10. Reassemble in reverse order, centering the wheel  
between the edges of the inlet venturi. If bearings  
were removed or replaced, be sure to reuse any  
shim stock found between the mounting support/  
plate and bearing housings.  
11. Torque all hardware.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
58  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Mounting Details –  
Disconnect and lock-out power from  
the unit anytime service is being per-  
formed on the fan section. Failure to  
do so could result in serious injury or  
death due to the fan turning on while  
work is in progress.  
1.Check the shaft - it should be straight, free of burrs  
and full size. Be sure the bearing is not seated on  
a worn section of shafting.  
2.Make certain any set screws are not obstructing  
the bearing bore.  
Fan Motor  
3.Align the bearing in its housing and slide the bear-  
ing into position on shaft - never hammer the ends  
of the inner race. If necessary, use a brass bar or  
pipe against the inner race to drift bearing into  
place - never hit the housing, as bearing damage  
may result. Make sure there is lubricant between  
the bearing outer ring and the housing.  
1.Shut off unit power and lock out.  
2.Disconnect and tag power wires at motor  
terminals.  
3.Loosen motor base-to-mounting-rail attaching  
bolts.  
4.Mark belt as to position. Remove and set aside  
belts.  
5.Remove motor bracket hold down bolts.  
6.Remove motor pulley and set aside.  
7.Remove motor.  
4.Fasten the bearing housing to the unit mounting  
support with hex head cap screws, washers, new  
lock washers and hex nuts before securing the bear-  
ing to the shaft. This permits the bearing to align  
itself in position along the shaft and eliminates any  
possibility of cramping loads.  
8.Install new motor. Reassemble by reversing steps  
1 - 6. Be sure to reinstall multiple belts in their  
original position. Use a complete new set if re-  
quired. Do not stretch belts over sheaves. Review  
the sections on motor and sheave installation,  
sheave alignment, and belt tensioning discussed  
previously.  
9.Reconnect motor leads and restore power. Check  
fan for proper rotation as described in Start-Up  
Check List.  
5.Rotate the shaft to make certain it turns freely.  
6.Bearings may employ one of several different  
methods to lock the bearing to the shaft.  
4
Shaft should be free from burrs. If old  
shaft is used, be sure a ball bearing is  
not seated on worn section and shaft  
is not bent.  
There are various degrees of self-alignment in bearings  
of the same manufacturer. The force required for the  
self-alignment of the bearings used in JOHNSON  
CONTROLS manufactured units has been specified  
and is closely monitored at the factory. If it is necessary  
to purchase a bearing locally, be sure it can be worked  
around in the housing with a short shaft made of wood  
or other soft material placed in the bearing.  
Fan Shaft Bearings  
General – When removing and replacing the bearings,  
care should be taken to ensure that the area where the  
bearings fit on the shaft does not become scored or  
damaged. The shaft in this area should be thoroughly  
cleaned before the bearing is removed and again before  
the new bearing is installed.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
59  
Maintenance  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Prior to installing the bearing on the shaft, it should  
be worked around in the housing to make sure that  
self-alignment will be obtained where the bearing is  
installed. After the shaft journal has been inspected for  
cleanliness, metal chips or burrs, the bearing is slipped,  
not forced, onto the shaft. Forcing the bearing onto the  
shaft by the use of flange, pillow block, or outer ring  
will damage the bearing internally. Force applied in this  
way transmits the load to the inner race through the balls  
in the bearing. Since the bearings are not designed for  
axial loading, the sides of the races in which the balls  
turn can be damaged. If the bearing cannot be made to  
slip onto the shaft by pressing on the inner ring of the  
bearing, check the shaft for burrs. Install the bearing so  
the part of the inner race, which receives the locking  
collar or contains setscrews, is toward the outside of  
the unit.  
Eccentric Type  
An eccentric self-locking collar is turned and driven  
with a punch in the direction of shaft rotation to lock  
the bearing inner ring to the shaft. See Figure 4-7.  
SEAL ASSEMBLY  
RECESSED CAM OR SELF-  
OUTER RING  
LOCKING COLLAR  
INNER RING  
SELF LOCKING COLLAR  
BALLS AND RACEWAY  
CAM OR INNER RING  
FIG. 4-6 – BEARING WITH ECCENTRIC CAM  
If the grease fitting must be changed on bearings that  
utilize a locking pin under the fitting, it is important  
to properly replace it. If an adapter or grease fitting of  
improper size and length is used, the locking pin may  
be either too tight or loose and can affect the alignment  
and re-lubrication of the bearing.  
When the eccentric collar is engaged to the cam on the  
bearing inner ring and turned in direction of rotation, it  
grips the shaft with a positive binding action. The collar  
is then locked in place with the setscrew provided in  
the collar.  
Bearing Lock Devices  
The self-locking collar is placed on the shaft with its  
cam adjacent to the cam on the end of the bearing’s wide  
inner ring. In this position, with collar and bearing cams  
disengaged, the collar’s bore is concentric with that of  
the bearing’s inner ring. The wide inner ring is loose  
on the shaft. By turning the collar in the direction of  
normal shaft rotation, the eccentric recessed cam will  
drop over and engage with the corresponding cam on  
the bearing inner, causing it to grip the shaft tightly with  
a positive binding action. See Figure 4-6 & 4-7. Make  
sure the two cams engage smoothly and the locking  
collar is down flat against the shoulder of the inner ring.  
The wide inner ring is now locked to the shaft. Using  
a punch or similar tool in the drilled hole of the collar,  
tap the tool lightly to lock the collar in the direction of  
normal shaft rotation.  
Various types of locking devices are used to secure  
bearing(s) to the fan shaft. Refer to the instructions  
packed with bearings for special information. Figure  
4-5 is a typical bearing with a setscrew-type locking  
device. The various locking devices can be classified  
under basic types: eccentric locking type, concentric  
locking type, and Skwezloc type.  
Set  
Screws  
Lube  
Fitting  
Lock  
Ring  
Seal  
As a final step, the setscrew is tightened. Torque per  
Table 4-2. It exerts a wedging action to hold the collar  
always in the engaged position, even under shock and  
reversing loads.  
Pillow  
Block  
To disassemble, loosen the setscrew and tap the collar  
in the direction opposite shaft rotation.  
Inner  
Race  
Outer  
Race  
00418VIP  
FIG. 4-5 – BEARING WITH SETSCREW TYPE  
LOCKING DEVICE  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
60  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 4-2 – SET SCREW TORQUE  
SET  
SCREW  
DIA.  
HEX. SIZE MIN. RECOMMENDED  
ACROSS  
FLATS  
LBS.  
TORQUE  
INCH  
FOOT  
LBS.  
LBS.  
1/4 1/8  
66 - 85  
5.5 - 7.2  
5/16  
5/32  
126 - 164  
10.5 - 13.7  
29.0 - 37.7  
3/8 3/16  
228 - 296  
19.0 - 24.7  
7/16  
7/32  
348 - 452  
1/2 1/4  
504 - 655  
42.0 - 54.6  
5/8 5/16  
1104 - 1435 92.0 - 119.6  
Torquing of Set-screws  
1.Torque screw “A” to 1/2 recommended torque.  
2.Torque screw “B” to full min. recommended  
value.  
3.Torque screw “A” to full recommended value.  
After proper installation of the  
bearing(s), run the unit for 10 to 15  
minutes. Shut the unit down and lock  
it out. Check for proper engagement  
of locking collar and tightness of set  
screw(s).  
4
When replacing split bearings, refer to manufacturers  
instruction provided with the bearing. It is extremely  
important to ensure that proper radial clearances are  
observed between the roller bearings and outer face.  
Failure to make proper adjustments will cause premature  
failure of the bearing.  
grease fitting  
BEARING INSTALLATION  
seal  
00536vip  
FIG. 4-8 – SPLIT BEARING  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
61  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
THIS PAGE INTENTIONALLY LEFT BLANK  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
62  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 5 – SEQUENCE OF OPERATION  
UNIT TYPE  
An “Occupancy Command” can be entered into  
the Simplicity Control using the Modbus com-  
munication feature. In order to use this feature  
“OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLED” must be en-  
abled using Parameter 71 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under the  
SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
The Simplicity Control is capable of being configured  
for either Constant Volume (CV) or Variable Air  
Volume (VAV) operation. To configure the unit for  
VAV operation a 10,000 to 20,000 ohm resister must be  
installed on the P7 (CV/VAV) connector on the control  
board. If no resister is installed the unit is configured  
for CV operation. The control board should already be  
configured from the factory based on the type of unit  
that was ordered. However, this item should be verified  
at the time of start up. This feature will also need to be  
configured if a replacement control board is installed.  
Space Sensor with Unoccupied Override Button  
– If the Override Button is pushed on the space  
sensor the control will switch to the Occupied  
mode until the Unoccupied Override Time has  
expired. The Unoccupied Override Time can be  
set between 0 and 240 minutes. The “UNOCCU-  
PIED OVERRIDE TIME” can be programmed  
by selecting Parameter 9 using the Simplicity  
control board PROGRAM key or by using the  
SYSTEMS OPTION tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
OCCUPIED / UNOCCUPIED MODE  
The unit can be placed in the occupied or unoccupied  
mode by four different methods.  
Digital Input -Aswitch, external time clock, etc.  
can be used to close a 24 voltAC circuit between  
the “R” and “OCC” connection on the field con-  
nection terminal block of the Simplicity control  
board. When the circuit is closed, the unit is in  
the Occupied mode. If the circuit is open, the  
unit is in the unoccupied mode. In order to use  
this feature “OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLED”  
must be enabled using Parameter 71 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
CONSTANT VOLUME MODE (CV)  
AConstant Volume (CV) unit can be controlled by four  
methods:  
5
Stage thermostat  
Communicated Space Temperature  
Hardwired Space Temperature  
Stand Alone  
Internal Schedule – The Simplicity Control can  
be programmed for a weekly schedule that al-  
lows two occupied and two unoccupied times  
for each day. The control can also be configured  
for up to 20 Holiday schedules. The start date,  
time, and number of days can be programmed in  
for each holiday. The weekly schedule can be  
programmed using the WEEKLY SCHEDULE  
SETTINGS tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package. The holiday schedule can be pro-  
grammed using the HOLIDAY SCHEDULE  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package. In  
order to use this feature “OCCUPIED INPUT  
ENABLED” must be disabled using Parameter  
71 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity  
control board or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
The control is self-configuring based on the inputs that  
are present. The controls means are listed in their order  
of priority. If the Simplicity Control sees a thermostat  
input it will respond to that input regardless of the status  
of the Space Temperature input. This feature allows  
the Service Technician to easily energize a cooling or  
heating function for troubleshooting regardless of a  
space temperature input.  
As long as the Simplicity Control is receiving a space  
temperature input from the BAS system, it will use  
the communicated value instead of a hard wired space  
temperature input.  
The following parameters must be programmed to allow  
cooling and/or heating operation:  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
63  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Occupied Cooling  
“COOLING MODE OPERATION ENABLED” – must  
be enabled using Parameter 53 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under the  
COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
Y1 – First Stage of Cooling – 1st compressor  
from System 1.  
Y2 – Second Stage of Cooling – 2nd compressor  
from System 1.  
“HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION”  
– must be enabled using Parameter 54 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or  
under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
Y3 – Third Stage of Cooling – 1st compressor  
from System 2.  
Y4 – Fourth Stage of Cooling – 2nd compressor  
from System 2.  
Thermostat Input  
Unoccupied Cooling  
The Simplicity Control is set up to receive the following  
cooling/heating inputs from the thermostat:  
Unoccupied cooling operation is the same as Occupied.  
Aprogrammable thermostat would be required in order  
to change the cooling temperature settings between  
occupied and unoccupied.  
The following System parameters must be programmed  
through the simplicity control:  
If the Simplicity Control receives both a “Y” cooling  
call and “W” heating call at the same time the control  
will function and operate in the heating mode.  
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” - This  
parameter must be programmed to 99.0º F. This can be  
programmed using parameter 10 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under the  
COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
The YPAL 50 to 65-ton unit has four stages of  
mechanical cooling available and it is recommended  
that a four stage cooling thermostat be used. However,  
a two stage cooling thermostat could be used by  
connecting Y1 from the thermostat to Y1 and Y2 on  
the Simplicity field connection terminal block and Y2  
from the thermostat toY3 andY4 on the Simplicity field  
connection terminal block.  
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” - This  
parameter must be programmed to 45.0º F. This can be  
programmed using parameter 11 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under the  
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
In this mode of operation, the Simplicity will operate  
as a two-stage control. On the 50 to 65 ton unit the  
compressors will be grouped as follows:  
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” - This  
parameter must be programmed to 99.0º F. This can be  
programmed using parameter 12 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under the  
COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
First stage – Compressors 1A and 1B – System  
1 compressors – minimum 30 second delay be-  
tween compressors.  
Second stage – Compressors 2A and 2B – Sys-  
tem 2 compressors – minimum 30 second delay  
between compressors.  
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” - This  
parameter must be programmed to 45.0º F. This can be  
programmed using parameter 13 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under the  
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
The unit uses tandem compressors,  
two compressors for System 1 and two  
compressors for System 2.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
64  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Occupied Heating  
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied  
The Simplicity Control will stage on the cooling as  
follows:  
There are three stages of heating available:  
W1 – First Stage of Heating  
W2 – Second Stage of Heating  
W3 – Third Stage of Heating  
At cooling start up  
– If the space temperature is between 1.5° F and  
1.9° F above the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING  
SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOL-  
ING SETPOINT” the control will turn on the  
first compressor from System 1 and turn on a  
5 minute timer.  
– If after 5 minutes the space temperature is  
between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV  
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV  
UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the  
control will bring on the second compressor  
of System 1 and start a 5-minute timer.  
OR  
– If the space temperature is greater than 2.0° F  
or more above the “CV OCCUPIED COOL-  
ING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring  
on the first compressor from System 1 and  
start a 3 minute timer. After 30 seconds, the  
control will bring on the second compressor  
from System 1.  
See the Heating section of this manual for a description  
of the heating staging.  
Unoccupied Heating  
Unoccupied heating operation is the same as Occupied.  
Aprogrammable thermostat would be required in order  
to change the heating temperature settings between  
occupied and unoccupied.  
Space Sensor – Hard Wired or Communicated  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Control:  
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” – us-  
ing Parameter 10 under the PROGRAM key on  
the Simplicity control board or under the COOL-  
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
5
If after 3 or 5 minutes the space temperature is  
between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV OC-  
CUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UN-  
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the control  
will bring on the first compressor from System 2  
and start a 5 minute timer.  
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-  
ing Parameter 11 under the PROGRAM key on  
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-  
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
If after 3 or 5 minutes the space temperature  
is 2.0° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring  
on the first compressor of System 2 and start a 3  
minute timer.  
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
– using Parameter 12 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under  
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
If after 3 or 5 minutes the space temperature  
is 1.5° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring on  
the second compressor of System 2.  
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”  
– using Parameter 13 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under  
the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
65  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The Simplicity Control will stage off the cooling as  
follows:  
The Simplicity Control will stage off the heat as  
follows:  
If the space temperature is within 0.5° F of the  
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or  
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
the control turns off the System 2 compressors,  
if on, with a 30 second delay between the com-  
pressors provided the minimum compressor run  
times have been satisfied.  
When the space temperature is 2.4° F below the  
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UNOC-  
CUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the third stage  
of heating will turn off.  
When the space temperature is 1.9° F below the  
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UNOC-  
CUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the second  
stage of heat will turn off.  
If the space temperature is equal to or below the  
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or  
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
the control turns off the System 1 compressors  
with a 30 second delay between the compressors  
provided the minimum compressor run times  
have been satisfied.  
When the space temperature is 0.1° F above the  
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UNOC-  
CUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the first stage  
of heating will turn off.  
The Simplicity Control has the following heating timing  
functions:  
The Simplicity Control has the following timing cooling  
functions:  
A minimum off time of 2 minutes.  
A minimum on time of 3 minutes.  
Minimum off time of 5 minutes.  
There is a 30 second time delay between stag-  
Minimum on time of 3 minutes – This param-  
eter can be programmed from between 1 and 10  
minutes using the COOLING SETUP tab of the  
in the Simplicity PC software package.  
es.  
Stand Alone  
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Control:  
The Simplicity Control will stage on the heat as  
follows:  
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” – us-  
ing Parameter 10 under the PROGRAM key on  
the Simplicity control board or under the COOL-  
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
When the space temperature is 1.5° F – 1.9° F  
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV  
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the  
control energizes the first stage of heat.  
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-  
ing Parameter 11 under the PROGRAM key on  
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-  
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
When the space temperature is 2.0° F – 2.4° F  
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV  
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the  
control energizes the second stage of heat.  
When the space temperature is 2.5° F or more  
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV  
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the  
control energizes the third stage of heat.  
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
– using Parameter 12 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under  
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
66  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”  
– using Parameter 13 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under  
the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
If after 3 or 5 minutes the return air temperature  
is 1.5° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring on  
the second compressor of System 2.  
“SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERIDE EN-  
ABLED” must be turned on – using Parameter  
8 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity  
control board or under the SYSTEM OPTIONS  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
The Simplicity Control will stage off the cooling as  
follows:  
If the return air temperature is within 0.5° F of  
the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
the control turns off the System 2 compressors,  
if on, with a 30 second delay between the com-  
pressors provided the minimum compressor run  
times have been satisfied.  
Cooling Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied  
The Simplicity Control will stage on the cooling as  
follows:  
If the return air temperature is equal to or below  
the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
the control turns off the System 1 compressors  
with a 30 second delay between the compressors  
provided the minimum compressor run times  
have been satisfied.  
At cooling start up  
– If the return air temperature is between 1.5°  
F and 1.9° F above the “CV OCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCU-  
PIED COOLING SETPOINT” the control  
will turn on the first compressor from System  
1 and turn on a 5 minute timer.  
– If after 5 minutes the return air temperature  
is between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV  
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV  
UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the  
control will bring on the second compressor  
of System 1 and start a 5-minute timer.  
OR  
– If the return air temperature is greater than  
2.0° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCU-  
PIED COOLING SETPOINT” the control  
will bring on the first compressor from System  
1 and start a 3 minute timer. After 30 seconds,  
the control will bring on the second compres-  
sor from System 1.  
The Simplicity Control has the following timing cooling  
functions:  
Minimum off time of 5 minutes.  
Minimum on time of 3 minutes – This param-  
eter can be programmed from between 1 and 10  
minutes using the COOLING SETUP tab of the  
in the Simplicity PC software package.  
5
Heating Operation – Occupied or Unoccupied  
The Simplicity Control will stage on the heat as  
follows:  
When the return air temperature is 1.5° F – 1.9°  
F below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or  
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”  
the control energizes the first stage of heat.  
If after 3 or 5 minutes the return air temperature  
is between 1.5° F and 1.9° F above the “CV  
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV  
UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” the  
control will bring on the first compressor from  
System 2 and start a 5 minute timer.  
When the return air temperature is 2.0° F – 2.4°  
F below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or  
“CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”  
the control energizes the second stage of heat.  
If after 3 or 5 minutes the return air temperature  
is 2.0° F or more above the “CV OCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED  
COOLING SETPOINT” the control will bring  
on the first compressor of System 2 and start a 3  
minute timer.  
When the return air temperature is 2.5° F or more  
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV  
UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the  
control energizes the third stage of heat.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
67  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The Simplicity Control will stage off the heat as  
follows:  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 24 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-  
plicity PC software package.  
When the return air temperature is 2.4° F below  
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UN-  
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the third  
stage of heating will turn off.  
The Simplicity Control initiates compressor operation  
as follows:  
When the return air temperature is 1.9° F below  
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UN-  
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the second  
stage of heat will turn off.  
The Simplicity Control will turn compressors on  
and off based of the difference between the sup-  
ply air temperature and the cooling set point.  
When the return air temperature is 0.1° F above  
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” or “CV UN-  
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” the first  
stage of heating will turn off.  
With no thermostat call or a Y1 first stage  
call the Simplicity Control will control to the  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT”. The Y1 input is not required to  
initiate compressor operation.  
The Simplicity Control has the following heating timing  
functions:  
When there is a Y2, Y3, or Y4 call from the  
thermostat the Simplicity Control will control to  
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT”.  
A minimum off time of 2 minutes.  
A minimum on time of 3 minutes.  
The control uses a 5-degree dead band around  
the cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP  
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.  
There is a 30 second time delay between stag-  
es.  
VARIABLE AIR VOLUME (VAV)  
When the supply air temperature is 5.0° F  
or more above the cooling “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will energize  
the first compressor.  
A Variable Air Volume (VAV) unit can be controlled  
by four methods:  
Stage thermostat  
Communicated Space Temperature  
Hardwired Space Temperature  
Stand Alone - Return Air Temperature  
The control records the supply air temperature  
right before the compressor is turned on and  
compares it to the supply air temperature after 5  
minutes of operation.  
Asecond compressor will be turned on if both of  
Cooling - Occupied with Thermostat  
the following criteria are met:  
– The supply air temperature is still 5.0° F or  
more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV  
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT”.  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Control for VAV operation:  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 23 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-  
plicity PC software package.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
68  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
– The Simplicity Control uses the temperature  
difference calculated when the first com-  
pressor was turned on to verify the supply  
air temperature will not drop 5.0° F or more  
below the cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV  
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT”. If turning a compressor on  
would result in the specified drop in supply  
air temperature, the second compressor will  
not be turned on.  
Any W thermostat input will energize all the available  
heat stages with a 30 second delay between stages.  
Occupied Cooling with Hard Wired or Communi-  
cated Space Sensor  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Control for VAV operation with  
a space sensor:  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 23 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-  
plicity PC software package.  
The same logic will be used to stage on compres-  
sor 3 and 4.  
The Simplicity Control turns off compressor operation  
as follows:  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 24 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-  
plicity PC software package.  
The supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more  
below the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP  
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.  
“VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT”  
– using Parameter 25 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under  
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
It has been more than 5-minutes since the last  
compressor was turned on.  
The compressors will be turned off in the reverse  
order they were turned on.  
Cooling – Unoccupied with Thermostat  
The Simplicity Control will control the operation of the  
compressors as follows:  
The operation is the same as Occupied Cooling with a  
Thermostat except:  
5
Ifthespacetemperatureis2.0°Formoreabovethe  
“VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT”  
the control will use the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.  
A Y1 call will energize the supply fan.  
The Simplicity Control will not bring on compres-  
sors until the supply air temperature is 5.0° F or  
more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP  
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.  
If the space temperature is not 2.0° F or more  
above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET  
SETPOINT” the control will use the “VAV  
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT”.  
Both of the above criteria must be met before the  
If the control is using the “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” per  
above the space temperature must be equal to or  
less than the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET  
SETPOINT” before the control would switch to  
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UP-  
PER SETPOINT”.  
Simplicity Control will bring on compressors.  
Occupied or Unoccupied Heating with a Thermo-  
stat  
The following parameter must be programmed through  
the Simplicity Control:  
The control uses a 5-degree dead band around the  
cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
UPPER SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING SUP-  
PLY AIR TEMP LOWERT SETPOINT”.  
“VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED”  
– must be turned on using Parameter 26 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control  
board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
69  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Heating – Occupied with a Hard Wired or Com-  
municated Space Sensor  
When the supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more  
above the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT  
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING SAT  
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will energize  
the first compressor.  
The following parameter must be programmed into the  
Simplicity Control:  
The control records the supply air temperature  
right before the compressor is turned on and  
compares it to the supply air temperature after 5  
minutes of operation.  
“VAVOCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED” This  
must be turned on using Parameter 26 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Sim-  
plicity PC software package.  
A second compressor will be turned if both of  
the following criteria are met:  
– The supply air temperature is still 5.0° F or  
more, greater then the “VAV UPPER COOL-  
ING SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER  
COOLING SAT SETPOINT”.  
– The Simplicity Control uses the temperature  
difference calculated when the first compres-  
sor was turned on to verify the supply air tem-  
perature will not drop 5.0° F or more below  
the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT  
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING  
SAT SETPOINT”. If turning on a compressor  
would result in the specified drop in supply  
air temperature, the second compressor will  
not be turned on.  
“MORNING WARM-UP/ VAV RETURN AIR  
TEMP SETPOINT” – using Parameter 29 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control  
board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-  
ing Parameter 27 under the PROGRAM key on  
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-  
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
The unit will initiate Occupied Heating when the  
following criteria is met:  
The same logic will be used to stage on compres-  
The space temperature is 2.0° F less than the  
sor 3 and 4.  
“VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”.  
The return air temperature is 0.1° F below the  
“MORNING WARM UP / VAV RETURN AIR  
TEMP SETPOINT”.  
The Simplicity Control turn off compressor operation  
as follows:  
The supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more  
below the ““VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP  
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.  
The unit will terminate Occupied Heating when the:  
The return air temperature is equal to the  
“MORNING WARM UP RAT SETPOINT”.  
It has been more than 5-minutes since the last  
compressor was turned on.  
The “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” should  
always be set below the “MORNING WARM UP RAT  
SETPOINT”.  
The compressors will be turned off in the reverse  
order they were turned on.  
Cooling – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Com-  
municated Space Sensor  
Heating – Unoccupied with a Hard Wired or Com-  
municated Space Sensor  
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied  
cooling with this method of control.  
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied  
heating with this method of control.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
70  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Occupied Cooling – Stand Alone  
• The control uses a 5-degree dead band around the  
cooling “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
UPPER SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING SUP-  
PLY AIR TEMP LOWERT SETPOINT”.  
• When the supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more  
above the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT  
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING SAT  
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will energize  
the first compressor.  
• The control records the supply air temperature  
right before the compressor is turned on and  
compares it to the supply air temperature after 5  
minutes of operation.  
Asecond compressor will be turned on if both of  
the following criteria are met:  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Control for VAV Stand Alone  
operation:  
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UP-  
PER SETPOINT” – using Parameter 23 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control  
board or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
• “VAV COOLING SUPPLYAIR TEMPLOWER  
SETPOINT” – using Parameter 24 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Sim-  
plicity PC software package.  
• “VAV SUPPLYAIR TEMPRESET SETPOINT”  
– using Parameter 25 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under  
the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
• “SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE EN-  
ABLED” must be turned on – using Parameter  
8 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity  
control board or under the SYSTEM OPTIONS  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
– The supply air temperature is still 5.0° F or  
more, greater then the “VAV UPPER COOL-  
ING SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER  
COOLING SAT SETPOINT”.  
– The Simplicity Control uses the temperature  
difference calculated when the first compres-  
sor was turned on to verify the supply air tem-  
perature will not drop 5.0° F or more below  
the cooling “VAV UPPER COOLING SAT  
SETPOINT” or “VAV LOWER COOLING  
SAT SETPOINT”. If turning on a compressor  
would result in the specified drop in supply  
air temperature, the second compressor will  
not be turned on.  
5
The Simplicity Control will control the operation of the  
compressors as follows:  
• The same logic will be used to stage on compres-  
sor 3 and 4.  
• If the return air temperature is 2.0° F or more  
above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET  
SETPOINT” the control will use the “VAV  
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT”.  
The Simplicity Control turns off compressor operation  
as follows:  
• If the return air temperature is not 2.0° F or  
more above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
RESET SETPOINT” the control will use the  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT”.  
• If the control is using the “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLYAIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” per  
above the return air temperature must be equal  
to or less than the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
RESET SETPOINT” before the control would  
switch to the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR  
TEMP UPPER SETPOINT”.  
• The supply air temperature is 5.0° F or more  
below the ““VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP  
UPPER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.  
• It has been more than 5-minutes since the last  
compressor was turned on.  
• The compressors will be turned off in the reverse  
order they were turned on.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
71  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Cooling – Unoccupied Stand Alone  
Heating – Unoccupied Stand Alone  
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied  
cooling with this method of control.  
The Simplicity Control cannot operate unoccupied  
heating with this method of control.  
Heating – Occupied Stand Alone  
CONDENSER FAN OPERATION  
The following parameters must be programmed into  
the Simplicity Control:  
A call for the operation of compressor 1A or 1B will  
close an output at terminal CF1 of the P13 connector.  
This 24 VAC output energizes the 6M contactor and  
turns on condenser fan 1. This 24 VAC output is also  
sent to pressure switch PS3. If the discharge pressure  
rises above 360 psig the PS3 switch closes and energizes  
the 7M contactor. The 7M contactor then energizes  
condenser fan 2. If the discharge pressure decreases  
below 300 psig the PS3 switch opens and de-energizes  
condenser fan 2.  
• “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED”  
– This must be turned on using Parameter 26  
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity  
control board or under the HEATING SETUP  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
• “MORNING WARM-UP/ VAV RETURN AIR  
TEMP SETPOINT” – using Parameter 29 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control  
board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
• “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” – us-  
ing Parameter 27 under the PROGRAM key on  
the Simplicity control board or under the HEAT-  
ING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
• “SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE EN-  
ABLED” must be turned on – using Parameter  
8 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity  
control board or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
A call for the operation of compressor 2A or 2B will  
close an output at terminal CF2 of the P13 connector.  
This 24 VAC output energizes the 8M contactor and  
turns on condenser fan 3. This 24 VAC output is also  
sent to pressure switch PS4. If the discharge pressure  
rises above 360 psig the PS4 switch closes and energizes  
the 9M contactor. The 9M contactor then energizes  
condenser fan 4. If the discharge pressure decreases  
below 300 psig the PS4 switch opens and de-energizes  
condenser fan 4.  
COOLING COMPRESSOR LOCKOUT  
This feature prevents operation of mechanical cooling  
when the outdoor temperature is below this set point.  
The unit will initiate Occupied Heating when the  
following criteria are met:  
“OUTDOORAIRTEMPCOOLINGLOCKOUT”  
- this parameter can be set using the COOLING  
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software pack-  
age. This parameter should never be programmed  
less then 45.0º F  
• The return air temperature is 2.0° F less than the  
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT”.  
• The return air temperature is 0.1° F below the  
“MORNING WARM UP / VAV RETURN AIR  
TEMP SETPOINT”.  
Sequence of Operation  
The “VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT” should  
always be set below the “MORNING WARM UP RAT  
SETPOINT”.  
If the outdoor temperature is 1.0º F below the  
“OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCK-  
OUT” the Simplicity Elite control will prevent  
compressor operation.  
The unit will terminate Occupied Heating when:  
When the outdoor temperature is 1.0º F above  
the “OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCK-  
OUT” compressor operation will be permitted.  
• The return air temperature is equal to the  
“MORNING WARM UP RAT SETPOINT”.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
72  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Configuration (Jumpers and Potentiometers)  
If the outdoor air temperature is less then the  
economizer supply air temperature set point,  
compressors will not operate regardless of the  
“OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCK-  
OUT” set point.  
The inverter is configured at the factory. The jumpers  
must be in the positions shown in Table 5-2.  
TABLE 5-2 – VFD JUMPERS  
J2  
J3  
J4  
J5  
J6  
J7  
J8  
J9  
REMOVE  
REMOVE  
REMOVE  
MIDDLE  
MIDDLE  
IN  
-
LOW AMBIENT OPERATION  
A condenser fan VFD can be installed on condenser  
fan # l. When this is installed compressor system 1  
(compressors 1A and 1B) can operate down to an  
outdoor temperature of 0.0º F. The VFD is located in  
an enclosure on the right hand side of the condenser  
section, to the right of the system 2 compressors.  
IN  
IN FOR 60 HZ  
REMOVE FOR 50 HZ  
Potentiometer settings are also preset at the factory.  
The potentiometers should be in the positions shown in  
Table 5-3. The potentiometers do not have numerical  
settings and are set according to the positions indicated.  
DO NOT change potentiometer settings unless they do  
not match the positioning of the potentiometers shown  
in Figure 5-1. Modifying these settings may cause  
damage to the unit, control problems, and/or poor  
operating efficiency.  
To enable low ambient operation when a condenser  
fan VFD is installed, the following parameter must be  
programmed:  
“LOWAMBIENT KITINSTALLED” - is enabled  
using Parameter 84 under the PROGRAM key  
of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the Simplicity  
PC software package.  
Operation and Pressure Control Range  
TABLE 5-3 – POTENTIOMETER SETTINGS  
P1  
P2  
The VFD controls the speed of the fan based on a  
discharge pressure setpoint and a differential range.  
When discharge pressure reaches approximately 270  
PSIG, the VFD will start the fan if the Unit Controller  
is calling for compressor / condenser fan operation. The  
binary outputs from the Unit Controller are as shown  
in Table 5-1.  
5
350 PSIG  
6 O’CLOCK  
80 PSIG  
6 O’CLOCK  
TABLE 5-1 – BINARY OUTPUTS  
TERMINAL  
CONDENSER  
FAN  
WIRE  
#
CONNECTOR  
CONTACTOR  
#
1A  
P13  
1
423  
6M  
As soon as the contactor is energized, the VFD will be  
activated and will begin to control. As the pressure rises  
over the next 80 PSIG (270 – 350 PSIG); the fan speed  
will increase to full speed at approximately 350 PSIG.  
LD113008  
P1  
P2  
FIG. 5-1 – CONDENSER FAN VFD POTENTIOMETER  
SETTINGS  
The VFD control input signal originates from the  
discharge pressure transducer for the compressor system  
it is controlling. The transducer signal feeds the VFD.  
The VFD controls the fan speed based on discharge  
pressure.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
73  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SUPPLY FAN OPERATION  
– If CONTINUOUS FAN OPERATION WITH  
SENSOR” is turned on using Parameter 55  
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity  
control board, or under the FANS tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package the supply  
fan will operate continuously whenever the  
unit is in the occupied mode.  
Constant Volume (CV)  
The following values need to be programmed:  
“COOL, FAN ON DELAY” – Using parameter 4 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
If “TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN  
WHEN START HEAT” is turned on using  
Parameter 7 under the PROGRAM key of  
the Simplicity control board or under the  
FANS tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package the supply fan will shut down on  
a call for heat and then start based on the  
“HEAT, FAN ON DELAY” programmed  
time.  
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” – Using parameter 5 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
“HEAT, FAN ON DELAY” – Using parameter 2 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
The supply fan will be de-energized when:  
The supply fan has been on for 30 seconds and  
anyone of the following occurs:  
“HEAT, FAN OFF DELAY” – Using parameter 3 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
– When the 24-volt input to terminal “G” of  
the Simplicity control terminal board is re-  
moved.  
– Any time the 24 volt input to terminal Y1,  
Y2, Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of the Simplic-  
ity control terminal board is removed and the  
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN  
OFF DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,  
FAN OFF DELAY” timer does not start until  
the control receives a signal that the gas valve  
is de-energized.  
– Any time there is a call for cooling or heating  
operation by a space sensor is lost and the  
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN  
OFF DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,  
FAN OFF DELAY” timer does not start until  
the control receives a signal that the gas valve  
is energized.  
The supply will be energized when:  
The supply fan has been off for 10 seconds and  
anyone of the following occurs:  
– There is a 24 volt input to terminal “G” of the  
Simplicity control terminal board.  
– There is a 24 volt input to terminal Y1, Y2,  
Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of the Simplicity con-  
trol terminal board and the “COOL, FAN ON  
DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN ON DELAY” have  
timed out. The “HEAT, FAN ON DELAY”  
timer does not start until the control receives  
a signal that the gas valve is energized.  
– There is a call for cooling or heating operation  
initiated by a space sensor demand and the  
“COOL, FAN ON DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN  
ON DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,  
FAN ON DELAY” timer does not start until  
the control receives a signal that the gas valve  
is energized.  
– When the unit goes into the unoccupied mode  
and there is no call for cooling or heating  
operation.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
74  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The Simplicity Control monitors the operation of the  
supply fan by checking the status of a digital input from  
an air proving switch. After 90 seconds of operation,  
the Simplicity Control looks for a high state (24-volt  
input) from the air proving switch circuit at the “APS”  
connections at the P11 connector on the Simplicity  
control board. If this input does not go to the high state  
in this time frame the Simplicity Control will set anAir  
Pressure Switch Unit Lockout,Alarm Code 24 and turn  
off all outputs.  
The supply fan will be de-energized when:  
The supply fan has been on for 30 seconds and  
anyone of the following occurs:  
– Any time the unit goes unoccupied and there  
is no call for cooling or heating operation.  
– Any time the 24 volt input to terminal Y1,  
Y2, Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of the Simplic-  
ity control terminal board is removed and the  
“COOL, FAN OFF DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN  
OFF DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,  
FAN OFF DELAY” timer does not start until  
the control receives a signal that the gas valve  
is de-energized.  
The Simplicity Control will retry the fan output every  
30 minutes for three retries. If after three retires it still  
cannot qualify the fan, it will continue the alarm and  
lock out all heating and cooling operation. If the switch  
closes during one of the restarts, the control will resume  
normal operation and clear the active alarm.  
The Simplicity Control monitors the operation of the  
supply fan by checking the status of a digital input from  
an air proving switch. After 90 seconds of operation,  
the Simplicity Control looks for a high state (24-volt  
input) from the air proving switch circuit at the “APS”  
connections at the P11 connector on the Simplicity  
control board. If this input does not go to the high state  
in this time frame the Simplicity Control will set anAir  
Pressure Switch Unit Lockout,Alarm Code 24 and turn  
off all outputs. The Simplicity Control also monitors  
the duct static pressure input during this time. If the  
duct static pressure is above 0.05” WC the control will  
generate a Air Pressure Switch Unit Lockout, Alarm  
Code 24 but continue to operate.  
An Air Pressure Switch Unit Lockout will also be  
declared if the input goes low, for 2 seconds, during  
normal supply fan operation.  
The Simplicity Control also monitors the supply fan  
operation in the off cycle. 90 seconds after the digital  
output from the Simplicity control supply fan circuit  
goes low (0 volts) the Simplicity Control checks the  
status of the digital input from the air proving switch  
circuit. If the state of the circuit remains high (24-volts)  
the Simplicity Control will set an Air Pressure Switch  
stuck closed, Alarm Code 25. As soon as the pressure  
switch opens, the Simplicity Control will resume normal  
operation.  
5
The Simplicity Control will retry the fan output every  
30 minutes for three retries. If after three retires it still  
cannot qualify the fan, it will continue the alarm and  
lock out all heating and cooling operation. If the switch  
closes during one of the restarts, the control will resume  
normal operation and clear the active alarm.  
On a call for supply fan operation, the Simplicity  
Control sends a 24 VAC signal from the FAN terminal  
of the P13 connector to the supply fan relay.  
Variable Air Volume (VAV)  
An Air Pressure Switch Unit Lockout will also be  
declared if the input goes low, for 2 seconds, during  
normal supply fan operation.  
The supply will be energized when:  
The supply fan has been off for 10 seconds and  
The Simplicity Control also monitors the supply fan  
operation in the off cycle. 90 seconds after the digital  
output from the Simplicity Control supply fan circuit  
goes low (0 volts) the Simplicity Control checks the  
status of the digital input from the air proving switch  
circuit. If the state of the circuit remains high (24-volts)  
the Simplicity Control will set an Air Pressure Switch  
stuck closed, Alarm Code 25. As soon as the pressure  
switch opens the Simplicity Control will resume normal  
operation.  
anyone of the following occurs:  
– The unit is in the occupied mode.  
– The unit is in the Unoccupied heating or  
cooling mode and there is a 24 volt input to  
terminal Y1, Y2, Y3, Y4, W1, W2, or W3 of  
the Simplicity control terminal board and the  
“COOL, FAN ON DELAY” or “HEAT, FAN  
ON DELAY” have timed out. The “HEAT,  
FAN ON DELAY” timer does not start until  
the control receives a signal that the gas valve  
is energized.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
75  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
VAV Supply Fan Speed Control  
The following parameter must be programmed to allow  
economizer operation:  
The following values need to be programmed:  
“DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT” – Using parameter  
30 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control  
board or under the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” – must be enabled using  
Parameter32underthePROGRAMkeyontheSimplicity  
control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
“DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT”  
– By using the FAN tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
Dry Bulb  
The following parameter must be programmed to allow  
economizer operation:  
The Simplicity Control uses a proportional-integral  
control algorithm to maintain the “DUCT PRESSURE  
SETPOINT” by varying the speed of the supply fan. As  
the duct static pressure goes up the speed goes down.  
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP ENABLE  
SETPOINT” – must be programmed using Parameter  
39 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control  
board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in  
the Simplicity PC software package.  
On a call for supply fan operation the Simplicity Control  
sends a 24 VAC signal from the FAN terminal of the  
P13 connector to the supply fan relay.  
The economizer will become active and use outdoor air  
for cooling when:  
The Duct Static Pressure Transducer has a range of 0.0  
to 5.0” WC. The transducer sends a 0.0 to 5.0 volt DC  
signal to the Simplicity Control through the DP+ and  
DP- connections at the P21 connector. The Simplicity  
Control then sends a 2.0 to 10.0 volt DC signal to the  
supply fan VFD through the VFD+, VFD- terminals at  
connector P14 to vary the speed of the VFD.  
The outside air temperature is less then or equal  
to the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP  
ENABLE SETPOINT”.  
The Simplicity Control has a demand for cooling  
operation.  
If the duct static pressure is equal to or greater than the  
“DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT” the  
Unit Controller will turn off all outputs and lockout  
until the control is reset.  
If the outdoor air temperature was above the  
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDEAIR TEMPENABLE  
SETPOINT” when the cooling cycle was initi-  
ated, the Simplicity Control will activate econo-  
mizer operation when the outdoor air temperature  
is 1.0° F below the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE  
AIR TEMP ENABLE SETPOINT”.  
ECONOMIZER  
Economizer is used in the cooling mode only. As soon  
as the unit switches into Occupied or Unoccupied  
Cooling and the conditions are within the programmed  
guidelines for economizer operation the Simplicity  
Control will attempt to use outdoor air to lower the  
supply air temperature to the active economizer set  
point. The Simplicity Control can be configured to use  
the following economizer control methods:  
The economizer will become inactive and eliminate the  
use of outdoor air for cooling when:  
The outside air temperature is 1.0° F greater than  
the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP EN-  
ABLE SETPOINT”.  
The Simplicity Control does not have an Occu-  
pied or Unoccupied cooling demand.  
Dry Bulb  
Single Enthalpy  
Dual Enthalpy  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
76  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Single Enthalpy  
Dual Enthalpy  
The following parameters must be programmed to allow  
economizer operation:  
The following parameter must be programmed to allow  
economizer operation:  
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY  
SETPOINT” – must be programmed using Parameter  
37 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control  
board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in  
the Simplicity PC software package.  
“RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”  
– must be enabled using Parameter 38 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or  
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”  
– must be enabled using Parameter 36 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or  
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“DIFFERENTIALENTHALPYMODEENABLEDmust  
be turned ON under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab  
in the Simplicity PC software package.  
The economizer will become active and use outdoor air  
for cooling when:  
The economizer will become active and use outdoor air  
for cooling when:  
The outside air enthalpy is 1.0 BTU/LB less then  
the return air enthalpy.  
The outside air enthalpy is less then or equal to  
the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY  
SETPOINT”.  
The Simplicity Control has a demand for cooling  
operation.  
The Simplicity Control has a demand for cooling  
The economizer will become inactive and eliminate the  
use of outdoor air for cooling when:  
operation.  
If the outdoor air enthalpy was above the  
“ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY  
SETPOINT” when the cooling cycle was initiated  
the Simplicity Control will activate economizer  
operation when the outdoor air enthalpy is 1.0  
BTU/LB below the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE  
AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT”.  
The outside air enthalpy is equal to or greater  
5
than the return air enthalpy.  
The Simplicity Control does not have an Occu-  
pied or Unoccupied cooling demand.  
BAS ECONOMIZER OPERATION  
The economizer will become inactive and eliminate the  
use of outdoor air for cooling when:  
This feature allows the outdoor/return air damper to be  
controlled by an external 2 to 10 VDC input.  
The outside air enthalpy is 1.0 BTU/LB greater  
than the “ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR  
ENTHALPY SETPOINT”.  
The following parameters must be programmed to allow  
BAS ECONOMIZER OPERATION:  
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” - must be disabled using  
Parameter32underthePROGRAMkeyontheSimplicity  
Control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
The Simplicity Control does not have an Occu-  
pied or Unoccupied cooling demand.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
77  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
“OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”  
- must be disabled using Parameter 36 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Control board or  
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT”  
– must be programmed using Parameter 34 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board  
or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED”  
- must be disabled using Parameter 38 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Control board or  
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
The Simplicity Control will try to modulate the outdoor  
air damper and the compressors to maintain the supply  
air temperature to +/- 1.0° F of the following set points  
based on the method of control:  
With a Y1 input from a thermostat the Simplic-  
ity Control will use the “ECONOMIZER FIRST  
STAGE SETPOINT”.  
“THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER INSTALLED”  
must be enabled using Parameter 58 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Control board or  
under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
With a Y2, Y3, or Y4 input from a thermostat the  
Simplicity Control will use the “ECONOMIZER  
SECOND STAGE SETPOINT”.  
When the space temperature is 1.5° F to 1.9°  
F above the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING  
SETPOINT” or “CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING  
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will use the  
“ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT”.  
In order to use this feature a 2 to 10 VDC external signal  
must be sent to the unit through the “BAS ECON +”  
and “BAS ECON -” connections on the Unit Control  
board.  
Sequence of Operation  
When the space temperature is 2.0° F above the  
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT” or  
“CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT”  
the Simplicity Control will use the “ECONO-  
MIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT”.  
The Unit Controller sends the 2 to 10 VDC input signal  
directly to the analog output terminals “ECO +” and  
“ECO -” to the damper actuator. A 2 VDC input from  
the external source will result in a 2 VDC signal to the  
damper actuator.  
Variable Air Volume Economizer Set Point  
If voltage is applied to the “BAS ECON  
+” and “BAS ECON -” terminals be-  
fore “THIRD PARTY BAS ECONO-  
MIZER INSTALLED” is enabled the  
Unit Controller can be damaged.  
The Simplicity Control will try to modulate the outdoor  
air damper and the compressors to maintain the supply  
air temperature to +/- 1.0° F of the following set points  
based on the method of control:  
With aY1 input from a thermostat the Simplicity  
Control will use the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP UPPER SETPOINT”.  
Constant Volume Economizer Set Point  
The following parameter must be programmed to allow  
economizer operation:  
With a Y2, Y3, or Y4 input from a thermostat the  
Simplicity Control will use the “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”.  
“ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT” – must be  
programmed using Parameter 33 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
When the space temperature is less then 2.0°  
F above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET  
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will use the  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT”.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
78  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
When the space temperature is equal to or greater  
than 2.0° F above the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
RESET SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will  
use the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LOWER SETPOINT”.  
As long as the supply air temperature is 5.1° F  
below the economizer set point and the Econo-  
mizer PI output is low (damper at minimum  
position setting) the Simplicity Control will turn  
off compressors every 3-minutes until all the  
compressor have been turned off.  
Economizer / Compressor Operation  
Economizer PI Loop (Proportional and Integral)  
The Simplicity Control will use outdoor air without  
compressor operation when the following is true:  
The Simplicity Control uses a proportional and integral  
logic (PI loop) to control the operation of the damper  
actuator. The Simplicity Control monitors the change  
in the supply air temperature to the economizer set point  
verses changes to the output to the damper actuator.  
When the supply air temperature is more then 2.0° F  
from the economizer set point the Simplicity Control  
will change the output to the economizer damper 1%  
every 2 seconds. If the supply air temperature is within  
+/- 2.0° F of the economizer set point the Simplicity  
Control will change the output to the economizer  
damper 0.5% every 2 seconds.  
Economizer is active.  
The outdoor air temperature is equal to or less  
then the economizer set point.  
The Simplicity Control will use outdoor air with  
compressor operation when the following is true:  
Economizer is active.  
The outdoor air temperature is above the econo-  
mizer set point.  
ECONOMIZER LOADING  
When outdoor air and compressor operation is available  
the compressors operation will be controlled as  
follows:  
Economizer Loading is a programmable option that  
can be used to place an artificial load on the unit to  
prevent cycling a compressor off when the supply  
air temperature approaches the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”.  
If the supply air temperature is 5.1° F or more  
above the economizer set point and the Econo-  
mizer PI output is saturated (100%) the Simplic-  
ity Control will turn on a compressor and start a  
3 minute timer.  
5
The following System Parameter must be  
programmed:  
If after 3-minutes the temperature is still 5.1° F  
above the economizer set point and the Econo-  
mizer PI output is saturated (100%) the Simplic-  
ity Control will bring on a second compressor and  
start a three minute timer.  
“ECONOMIZER LOADING ENABLE” – must be  
enabled under the COOLING SETUP tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”  
must be programmed using the COOLING SETUP tab  
in the Simplicity PC software package.  
This sequence would continue until all the com-  
pressors on.  
If after the 3-minute timing the supply air tem-  
perature is within +/- 5.0° F of the economizer  
set point no change will be made to the number  
of compressors operating.  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING” must  
be enabled using the COOLING SETUP tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
If after the 3-minute timing the supply air tem-  
perature is 5.1° F or more below the economizer  
set point and the Economizer PI output is low  
(dampers at the minimum position setting) the  
Simplicity Control will turn off a compressor.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
79  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Constant Volume  
The unit must be configured as a Variable Air  
Volume unit.  
The unit must be in an occupied or unoccupied  
The following conditions must be met in order for  
Economizer Loading to function:  
cooling mode.  
The sequence of operation is as follows:  
The outdoor air temperature must be greater than  
the return air temperature.  
When the supply air temperature is 5.1° F less  
than the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP UP-  
PER SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” the  
economizer damper will start to open.  
Economizer must be installed but not active.  
A call for first stage compressor operation only  
The unit must be configured as a Constant Volume  
unit.  
If the economizer damper opens 100% and the  
supply air temperature is still 5.1° F less than  
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP UPPER  
SAT SETPOINT” or “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” the Simplicity  
Control will turn off the compressor close the  
economizer damper to its minimum position.  
The unit must be in an occupied or unoccupied  
cooling mode.  
The sequence of operation is as follows:  
When the supply air temperature is 0.1° F less  
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING  
SETPOINT” the economizer damper will start to  
open.  
When the supply air temperature is between  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP UPPER SAT  
SETPOINT” and the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” plus 5.0° F  
the economizer damper movement will stop and  
maintain the current position.  
If the economizer damper opens 100% and the  
supply air temperature is still 0.1° F less than  
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING  
SETPOINT” the Simplicity Control will turn off  
the compressor per the Excessive SAT sequence  
and close the economizer damper to its minimum  
position.  
When the supply air temperature is between  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY TEMP LOWER SAT  
SETPOINT” and the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
TEMP LOWER SAT SETPOINT” plus 7.0° F  
the economizer damper movement will stop and  
maintain the current position.  
When the supply air temperature is between  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING  
SETPOINT” and the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.0° F the  
economizer damper movement will stop and  
maintain the current position.  
When the supply air temperature is equal to 5.1°  
F or more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
TEMP UPPER SAT SETPOINT” and 5 minutes  
has expired since the economizer damper started  
to open, the economizer damper will close back  
to its minimum position and a second compressor  
will come on.  
When the supply air temperature is equal to 5.1°  
F or more above the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT  
COOLING SETPOINT” the economizer damper  
will close back to its minimum position.  
When the supply air temperature is equal to 7.1°  
F or more above the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY  
TEMP LOWER SAT SETPOINT” and 5 minutes  
has expired since the economizer damper started  
to open, the economizer damper will close back  
to its minimum position and a second compressor  
will come on.  
Variable Air Volume  
The following conditions must be met in order for  
Economizer Loading to function:  
The outdoor air temperature must be greater than  
the return air temperature.  
Economizer must be installed but not active.  
A call for first stage compressor operation only.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
80  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
COMFORT VENTILATION  
The following parameters must be programmed:  
“COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOLING  
ENABLED” - must be enabled under the COOLING  
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
Comfort Ventilation is a Constant Volume control  
mode that uses the economizer to control the supply  
air temperature. When outdoor air conditions allow,  
the economizer will modulate the outside / return air  
mix to keep supply air temperatures within the upper  
and lower Comfort Ventilation set points. The control  
will modulate the economizer, and energize cooling or  
heating if necessary, to keep the supply air temperature  
within the Comfort Ventilation set points, even though  
the space temperature requirements are satisfied.  
“COMFORT VENTILATION FOR HEATING  
ENABLED” - must be enabled under the HEATING  
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
“COMFORT VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT” -  
must be programmed under the COOLING SETUP or  
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
The following criteria must be present in order for  
Comfort Ventilation to function”:  
“COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER SETPOINT” -  
must be programmed under the COOLING SETUP or  
HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
The unit can not be in an active heating or cooling  
mode.  
The unit must have an economizer installed.  
The unit must be in the occupied mode.  
The unit should be placed in the continuous in-  
door fan operation mode.  
The unit type must be Constant Volume.  
TABLE 5-4 OPERATION DURING OFF CYCLE  
OAT VS OAT COMFORT ZONE SAT VS SAT COMFORT ZONE ECON OPERATION HEAT STAGE COMP STAGE  
BELOW  
BELOW  
BELOW  
ABOVE  
ABOVE  
ABOVE  
WITHIN  
WITHIN  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
OPEN  
-
-
-
TURN ON  
5
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
TURN ON  
OPEN  
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPEN  
OPEN  
-
TABLE 5-5 COMPRESSOR ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED  
OAT VS OAT COMFORT ZONE SAT VS SAT COMFORT ZONE ECON OPERATION HEAT STAGE COMP STAGE  
BELOW  
BELOW  
BELOW  
ABOVE  
ABOVE  
ABOVE  
WITHIN  
WITHIN  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
OPEN  
-
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
LEAVE ON  
LEAVE ON*  
LEAVE ON  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
-
TURN ON  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPEN  
-
OPEN  
OPEN  
-
* If the economizer damper opens to 100%, the compressor will turn off and the economizer damper will remain  
at 100%.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
81  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 5-6 HEAT STAGE ON WHEN SPACE INPUT SATISFIED  
OAT VS OAT COMFORT ZONE SAT VS SAT COMFORT ZONE ECON OPERATION HEAT STAGE COMP STAGE  
BELOW  
BELOW  
BELOW  
ABOVE  
ABOVE  
ABOVE  
WITHIN  
WITHIN  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
ABOVE  
BELOW  
WITHIN  
OPEN  
LEAVE ON*  
LEAVE ON  
LEAVE ON  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
TURN OFF  
-
-
-
-
-
-
TURN ON  
OPEN  
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPEN  
OPEN  
-
EXCESSIVE SAT (SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE)  
CONTROL  
Sequence of Operation  
Tables 5-4 thru 5-6 use the following definitions:  
This feature is only available on Constant Volume  
units. On a Constant Volume unit, the compressors  
and heat stages are control by the space temperature  
only, either by thermostat or zone sensor. As long as  
the room device is calling for cooling or heating the  
compressors or heating section does not control the  
actual temperature of the supply air leaving the unit.  
The enabling of this feature adds a means to prevent low  
or high supply air temperatures from being delivered to  
the conditioned space.  
SAT COMFORT ZONE – the temperature be-  
tween the “COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER  
SETPOINT” minus 1.0° F and the “COMFORT  
VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT” plus 1.0°  
F.  
OAT COMFORT ZONE - the temperature be-  
tween the “COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER  
SETPOINT” and the “COMFORT VENTILA-  
TION UPPER SETPOINT”.  
OAT – Outdoor Air Temperature.  
SAT – Supply Air Temperature.  
Cooling  
ECON OPERATION – Economizer damper will  
open to BRING SAT into the SAT COMFORT  
ZONE.  
The following System Parameters must be  
programmed:  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING  
ENABLED”- must be enabled using Parameter 14 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or  
under the COOLING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
Conditions of Operation  
In order for compressor operation “COMFORT  
VENTILATION FOR COOLING ENABLED”  
must be enabled.  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”  
– Using Parameter 15 under the PROGRAM key on  
the Simplicity control board or under the COOLING  
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
In order for heat stages to operate “COMFORT  
VENTILATION FOR HEATING ENABLED”  
must be enabled.  
Economizer operation will occur with either, or  
both, “COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOL-  
ING ENABLED” or “COMFORT VENTILA-  
TION FOR HEATING ENABLED” enabled.  
If a single compressor is energized the control will  
monitor the supply air temperature and respond as  
follows:  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
82  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply  
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”. If  
the supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more below  
this value and the compressor minimum run time  
requirement has been met the Simplicity Control  
will turn off the compressor.  
The Simplicity Control will continue to turn  
off compressors every 3 minutes until the sup-  
ply air temperature is equal to or greater than  
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING  
SETPOINT”.  
If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature  
is equal to or greater than the “SUPPLY AIR  
TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1°  
F the Simplicity Control will turn the staged off  
compressor(s) back on provided there is still a  
demand for the use of the staged off compres-  
sor.  
The Simplicity Control then starts a 10-minute  
timer.  
If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is  
equal to or greater than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F the  
Simplicity Control will turn the compressor back  
on provided there is still a demand for the staged  
off compressor.  
If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is  
not less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT  
COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F the Simplic-  
ity Control will keep the compressor(s) off until  
the supply air temperature is equal to or greater  
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING  
SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F. The Simplicity Control  
will then turn the compressor(s) back on provided  
there is still a demand for the staged off compres-  
sor.  
If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is  
not less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT  
COOLING SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F Simplic-  
ity Control will keep the compressor off until  
the supply air temperature is equal to or greater  
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING  
SETPOINT” plus 5.1° F. The Simplicity Control  
will then turn the compressor back on provided  
there is still a demand for the staged off compres-  
sor.  
Heating  
The following System Parameters must be  
programmed:  
If multiple compressors are energized the control will  
monitor the supply air temperature and respond as  
follows:  
5
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING  
ENABLED”- must be enabled using Parameter 16 under  
the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity control board or  
under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply  
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT”. If  
the supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more below  
this value and the compressor minimum run time  
requirement has been met the Simplicity Control  
will turn off the compressor with the shortest run  
time.  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”  
– Using Parameter 17 under the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity control board or under the HEATING SETUP  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
The Simplicity Control starts a 10 minute and 3  
If a single heat stage is on the control will monitor the  
supply air temperature and respond as follows:  
minute timing sequence.  
If after 3 minutes, the supply air temperature  
is still 0.1° F below the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT” the control will  
turn off the next compressor with the shortest run  
time.  
The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply  
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”. If the  
supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more above  
this value and the heat stage minimum run time  
has been met the Simplicity Control will turn off  
the heat stage.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
83  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The Simplicity Control then starts a 3 minute  
If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature  
is still greater than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F the  
Simplicity Control will keep the heat stage(s) off  
until the supply air temperature is equal to or less  
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING  
SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F. The Simplicity Con-  
trol will turn the heat stage(s) back on provided  
there is still a demand for the staged off heat  
stage.  
timer.  
If after 3 minutes the supply air temperature is  
equal to or less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F the  
Simplicity Control will turn the heat stage back  
on provided there is still a demand for the staged  
off heat stage.  
If after 3 minutes the supply air temperature is  
not equal to or less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F the  
Simplicity Control will keep the heat section off  
until the supply air temperature is equal to or less  
than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING  
SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F. The Simplicity Con-  
trol will turn the heat stage back on provided there  
is still a demand for the staged off heat stage.  
SPACE SENSOR WITH SET POINT ADJUSTMENT  
A space sensor with a 20 K ohm slide potentiometer  
can be used to reset the Occupied Cooling and Heating  
set points.  
In addition to the use of a space sensor with the  
slide potentiometer the following parameter must be  
programmed:  
If multiple heat stages are on the control will monitor  
the supply air temperature and respond as follows:  
“SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE” – The  
offset range must be programmed using Parameter  
56 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite  
control board or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab  
in the Simplicity Elite software package.  
The Simplicity Control will monitor the supply  
air temperature and compare it to the “SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”. If the  
supply air temperature is 0.1° F or more above  
this value and the heat stage minimum run time  
requirement has been met the Simplicity Control  
will turn off the heat section with the shortest run  
time.  
Sequence of Operation  
As the slide potentiometer is moved the Occupied  
Cooling and Heating set point is changed based on  
the programmed “SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET  
RANGE”. The “SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET  
RANGE” can be set from 0 to 5.0° F. For example,  
if the “SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE”  
is programmed for 3.0° F and the resistance of the  
potentiometer is lowered the Cooling and Heating set  
points would be lowered up to 3.0° F. If the resistance  
is increased the Cooling and Heating set points would  
be increased up to 3.0° F.  
The Simplicity Control starts a 3 minute and  
30 second timing sequence. If after 30 seconds  
the supply air temperature is still 0.1° F above  
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING  
SETPOINT”, the control will turn off the next  
heat stage with the shortest run time.  
The Simplicity Control will continue to turn off  
heat stages every 30 seconds until the supply air  
temperature is equal to or less than the “SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT”.  
If after 10 minutes the supply air temperature is  
equal to or less than the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT” minus 10.1° F  
the Simplicity Control will turn the heat stage(s)  
back on provided there is still a demand for the  
use of the staged off heat stage.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
84  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE  
The following parameter must be enabled in order to  
use to feature:  
The Unit Controller will self configure when it identifies  
a space sensor has been installed. Once it identifies that  
a space sensor is connected, if the input is then removed  
the control will generate a Space Temperature Sensor  
Alarm (19). When this occurs the unit will continue to  
operate and will use the return air temperature input  
in place of the space sensor. If the “SPACE SENSOR  
FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE” is turned on, the Alarm  
is removed and the unit will continue to use the return  
air temperature input until the space sensor input is  
within range and “SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE  
ENABLE” has been turned off.  
“REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLE FOR THIRD  
PARTY BAS” must be enabled using Parameter 22 under  
the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board  
or under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab of the Simplicity  
PC software package.  
Sequence of Operation  
The Simplicity Elite control will vary the active cooling  
set point per the following:  
Reset voltage less than 1.5 volts DC – No com-  
“SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE”  
is enabled using parameter 8 under the PROGRAM  
key of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab of the Simplicity software  
package.  
pressor operation.  
Reset voltage 1.5 to 2.0 volts DC - “VAV  
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT”.  
Reset voltage 10.0 volts DC - “VAV COOLING  
Sequence of Operation  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER SETPOINT”.  
Reset voltage between 2.0 and 10.0 volts DC  
– linearly between the “VAV COOLING SUP-  
PLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” and  
“VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT”.  
When the unit is configured as a Constant Volume unit  
with space sensor the Simplicity Control will use the  
same logic for controlling compressors, economizer,  
and heating that it would use with a space sensor but  
uses the return air temperature input instead of the  
space sensor.  
5
The hard wired input is connected to the Sim-  
plicity Elite control board at the “REM+” and  
“REM-“ terminals of the P19 connector.  
When unit is configured for VAV with space sensor,  
the Simplicity Elite control will use the return air  
temperature in place of the space sensor to reset between  
the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT” and the “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR  
TEMP LOWER SETPOINT” based on the return air  
temperature in relation to the “VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
RESET SETPOINT”.  
REDLINE  
The feature can be used to temporally reduce the  
electrical consumption of the unit by reducing the  
number of compressor that are turned on. This feature is  
only available as a communicated input to the Simplicity  
Elite control. The BACnet name is SET_REDLINE and  
the BACnet instance number is BV12. For Modbus use  
address (HEX) 41L, address (DEC) 65L Bit 0.  
REMOTE CONTROL  
This feature can be used on a VAV unit to send a  
hardwired 0 to 10 volts signal to the unit to vary the  
supply air temperature set point between the “VAV  
COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER SETPOINT”  
and “VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT”. This feature will only work on a VAV  
unit with space sensor control.  
Sequence of Operation  
If three or more compressors are energized when the  
Simplicity Elite control receives this command the  
Simplicity Control will turn off compressor number  
3 and 4 if energized even if the minimum run time  
requirement has not been met.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
85  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The Simplicity Elite control will keep the compressors  
off line for 5 minutes. After 5 minutes, the Simplicity  
Elite control will turn the compressor back on with a 30  
second delay between compressors and resume normal  
operation.  
In order to use this feature a pressure switch must be  
installed and the feature enabled. To enable the dirty  
filter feature.  
“DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INSTALLED” – must be  
enabled using Parameter 51 under the PROGRAM  
key of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab in the Simplicity  
PC software package.  
After 5 minutes Simplicity Elite control will reset this  
communicated input back to “OFF” regardless of the  
communicated status. To initiate another cycle the  
communicated value would have to switch to the low  
state “OFF” and then back to the high state “ON”.  
Sequence of Operation  
LOADSHED  
The control monitors the voltage input at terminals  
“FILT” at the P22 connector on the Simplicity Elite  
control board. If the status goes high, 24 volt input,  
for ten minutes the Simplicity Elite control will initiate  
an Alarm 23 “Dirty Filter Switch Has Tripped” but the  
operation of the unit will continue.  
This feature can be used to temporally reduce the  
electrical consumption of the unit by turning off all the  
active compressors. The feature is only available as a  
communicated input to the Simplicity Elite control. The  
BACnet name is SET_LOADSHED and the BACnet  
instance number is BV13. For Modbus use address  
(HEX) 41L, address (DEC) 65L Bit 1.  
As soon as the 24-volt input is removed from the input  
terminals, the alarm will turn off.  
Sequence of Operation  
METRIC OPERATION  
When this feature is turned on all the temperature data  
will be converted to metric.  
If compressors are energized when the Simplicity Elite  
control receives this command the Simplicity Elite  
control will turn off all compressor immediately, even  
if the minimum run time requirement has not been met  
for the compressor.  
The following must be enabled for Metric Operation:  
“METRIC OPERATION”- must be enabled using  
Parameter 57 under the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board.  
The Simplicity Elite control will keep the compressors  
off line for 5 minutes. After 5 minutes, the Simplicity  
Elite control will turn the compressor back on and  
resume normal information. The same compressors that  
were running before the Loadshed input was received  
will be turned back on with a 30 second delay between  
compressors.  
INTELLI-START  
This feature can be used to energize the heating or  
cooling function of the unit to bring the temperature of  
the space up to the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING” and  
“CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set points prior to the  
start of the occupied period.  
After 5 minutes, Simplicity Elite control will reset this  
communicated input back to “OFF” regardless of the  
communicated status. To initiate another cycle the  
communicated value would have to switch to the low  
state “OFF” and then back to the high state “ON”.  
The following parameter must be programmed in order  
to use this feature:  
DIRTY FILTER  
“INTELLI-START OPERATION ENABLE” – must be  
enabled under the SYSTEMS OPTIONS tab of the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
Aadjustable differential pressure switch can be a added  
to the unit to monitor the filters and initiate an alarm  
when the pressure drop across the filters become greater  
than the setting of the switch. When the switch closes,  
the alarm will be initiated.  
The following criteria must be met for Morning Warm-  
up operation:  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
86  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
– The Simplicity Elite control will record the  
space temperature and how long it takes to  
bring the space temperature to the “CV OC-  
CUPIED COOLING” set point.  
– When the “CV OCCUPIED COO0LING” set  
point is reached the Simplicity Elite control  
will divide the elapsed time into 5-minute  
increments.  
Intelli-Start will only work on a Constant Volume  
system using a space sensor.  
Intelli-Start will only work when the internal  
scheduling feature is used. It will not work using  
a hard wired or communicated Occupied com-  
mand.  
Intelli-Start will only function during the first  
occupied period of each day.  
– The Simplicity Elite control will determine  
how many 0.1° F the temperature was above  
the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING” set point  
Sequence of Operation  
– The Simplicity Elite control will then cal-  
culate how many 0.1° F were satisfied per  
5-minute increment.  
First day of heating or cooling operation  
Two hours prior to the start of the occupied period  
the Simplicity Control will compare the space  
temperature to the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING”  
or the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set points.  
– This number will be recalculated each day.  
– The Simplicity Elite control also records the  
outdoor temperature when the above calcula-  
tions are made.  
Heating operation  
– If the space temperature is 1.5° F or more  
below the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set  
point the Simplicity Elite control will stage on  
the heat using the normal heating with space  
sensor logic.  
– The Simplicity Elite control will record the  
space temperature and how long it takes to  
bring the space temperature to the “CV OC-  
CUPIED HEATING” set point.  
Subsequent Operation  
Each morning two hours before the scheduled  
occupied start time the Simplicity Elite control  
looks at the space temperature and the “CV OC-  
CUPIED COOLING” and “CV OCCUPIED  
HEATING” set points and determines if there is  
a need for cooling or heating operation.  
Based on which need is identified the Simplicity  
Elite control will calculate the number of 0.1°  
F increments the space temperature is from set  
point and multiple this value time the previous  
days calculation on the number of 0.1° F the unit  
can satisfy in 5 minutes. This will determine  
how many minutes prior to the beginning of the  
occupied period the control will need to start the  
heating or cooling operation.  
– When the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set  
point is reached the Simplicity Elite control  
will divide the elapsed time into 5-minute  
increments.  
– The Simplicity Elite control will determine  
how many 0.1° F the temperature was below  
the “CV OCCUPIED HEATING” set point.  
– The Simplicity Elite control will then cal-  
culate how many 0.1° F were satisfied per  
5-minute increment.  
5
If cooling mode is selected the Simplicity Elite  
control will also compare the current outdoor  
temperature to the outdoor temperature recorded  
during the previous days start up period.  
– This number will be recalculated each day.  
– The Simplicity Elite control also records the  
outdoor temperature when the above calcula-  
tions are made.  
– If the current outdoor air temperature is  
10.0° F or more above the previous day the  
Simplicity Elite control will add 5 minutes to  
the above calculated recovery time for every  
10.0° F difference.  
Cooling operation  
– If the space temperature is 1.5° F or more  
above the “CV OCCUPIED COOLING” set  
point the Simplicity Elite control will stage on  
cooling operation using the normal Cooling  
with space sensor logic.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
87  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The following criteria must be met for Morning Warm-  
up operation:  
If heating mode is selected the Simplicity Elite  
control will also compare the current outdoor  
temperature to the outdoor temperature recorded  
during the previous start up period.  
Morning Warm-up will only work on a VAV  
– If the current outdoor air temperature is 10.0°  
F or more below the previous day the Simplic-  
ity Elite control will add 5inutes to the above  
calculated recovery time for every 10.0° F  
difference.  
system.  
Morning Warm-up will only work when the in-  
ternal scheduling feature is used. It will not work  
using a hard wired or communicated Occupied  
command.  
The outdoor damper will be kept closed during  
this period unless it is being used to meet the oc-  
cupied cooling space temperature requirement.  
Morning Warm-up will only function during the  
first occupied period of each day.  
Even if the space temperature satisfies the “CV  
OCCUPIED COOLING” and “CV OCCUPIED  
HEATING” set points the unit will not switch  
to the occupied mode until the calculated warm  
up / cool down time has expired. However, the  
supply fan will remain energized during this  
time. If the space temperature rises above the  
“CV OCCUPIED COOLING”, or below the “CV  
OCCUPIED HEATING” set points during this  
time the cooling or heating will cycle back on.  
Sequence of Operation  
One hour before the beginning of the occupied  
period the Simplicity Elite control will energize  
the supply fan circuit.  
The Simplicity Elite control will keep the econo-  
mizer damper closed.  
After 5 minutes of supply fan operation the Sim-  
plicity Elite control will compare the return air  
temperature to the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV  
RETURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT”.  
MORNING WARM-UP  
If the return air temperature is 2.0° F or more  
below the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAVRETURN  
AIR TEMP SETPOINT” the Simplicity Elite  
control will energize all the available heat.  
This feature can be used to energize the heating section  
of the unit to bring the temperature of the space up to  
conditions prior to the start of the occupied period.  
If the return air temperature is not 2.0° F or  
more below the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV  
RETURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT” the Simplicity  
Elite control will continue supply fan operation  
while continuing to monitor the return air tem-  
perature.  
The following parameters must be programmed in order  
to use this feature:  
“MORNING WARM-UP ENABLE” – must be enabled  
using Parameter 28 under the PROGRAM key of the  
Simplicity Elite control board or under the HEATING  
SETUP tab of the Simplicity PC software package.  
When the return air temperature is equal to or  
above the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV RE-  
TURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT” heating operation  
will be de-energized.  
“MORNING WARM-UP/VAV RETURN AIR TEMP  
SETPOINT” - must be programmed using Parameter  
29 under the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite  
control board or under the HEATING SETUP tab of  
the Simplicity PC software package.  
During this time the heat will cycle on and off  
based on the comparison of the return air tem-  
perature to the “MORNING WARM-UP/VAV  
RETURN AIR TEMP SETPOINT”.  
“HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION”  
– must be enabled using Parameter 54 under the  
PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board  
or under the HEATING SETUP tab of the Simplicity  
PC software package.  
After one hour of operation the Simplicity Elite  
control will go into the Occupied mode and open  
the economize to the minimum position.  
Heating operation will continue until the return  
air temperature is equal to or above the “MORN-  
ING WARM-UP/VAV RETURN AIR TEMP  
SETPOINT”.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
88  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
HYDRONIC HEAT  
The following parameters must be programmed to use  
Hydronic Heat:  
The normal output to the valve is 2 VDC for 0% opening  
of the hydronic valve and 10 VDC for 100% opening of  
the hydronic valve. If the following is enabled:  
“HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION”  
must be enabled using Parameter 54 under the  
PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board  
or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity  
PC software package.  
“HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE  
ACTING” must be enabled using Parameter 21 under  
the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite control board  
or under the HEATING SETUP tab in the Simplicity  
PC software package.  
“HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED” must be enabled  
using Parameter 18 under the PROGRAM key of the  
Simplicity Elite control board or under the HEATING  
SETUP tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
Under this condition, the normal output to the valve is  
10 VDC for 0% opening of the hydronic valve and 0  
VDC for 100% opening of the hydronic valve.  
HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE STAT  
“HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR  
SETPOINT” must be programmed using Parameter  
19 under the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite  
control board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in  
the Simplicity PC software package.  
All hydronic heat units are equipped with a freeze stat  
that monitors the temperature of the return air. The  
switch action is normally closed and opens when the  
return air temperature is less the 40.0º F. The 24 VAC  
signal to the freeze stat originates at terminal FSP on  
the control board. The 24 VAC input from the freeze  
stat enters the control at the FSI terminal.  
“HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR  
SETPOINT” must be programmed using Parameter  
20 under the PROGRAM key of the Simplicity Elite  
control board or under the HEATING SETUP tab in  
the Simplicity PC software package.  
When the freeze stat input is lost, the Simplicity Control  
will send a 10 VDC signal to the valve (direct acting), 2  
VDC (reverse acting) to open the valve. The valve will  
continue to drive open for 5 minutes, even if the freeze  
stat circuit remakes. If the freeze stat circuit closes and  
the 5 minute timing has expired, the unit will return to  
normal operation.  
Sequence of Operation  
5
On Constant Volume units whenever there is a call for  
the 1st stage of heating operation the Simplicity Elite  
control will vary a 2 to 10 VDC output to the hydronic  
valve to try and maintain the supply air temperature to  
within +/- 1.0° F of the “HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE  
#1 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT”. The output to the valve  
can be found at terminal “HWV+” and “HWV-“ at  
connector P14 on the Simplicity Elite control board.  
If the supply fan is operating and the outdoor damper  
is open the Simplicity Control will close the damper  
during the above sequence.  
VENTILATION  
On Constant Volume units whenever there is a call for  
the 2nd stage of heating operation the Simplicity Elite  
control will vary a 2 to 10 VDC output to the hydronic  
valve to try and maintain the supply air temperature to  
within +/- 1.0° F of the “HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE  
#2 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT”.  
The unit can be ordered / programmed for the following  
ventilation options:  
None.  
Manual.  
Fixed Minimum – Economizer option required.  
On a VAV unit whenever there is a call for heat the  
Simplicity Elite control will vary the 2 to 10 VDC output  
to the hydronic valve to try and maintain the supply  
air temperature to within 1º F of the “HYDRONIC  
HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLYAIR SETPOINT”  
Demand Ventilation – Economizer option re-  
quired.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
89  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Manual  
Demand Ventilation  
This option uses a manually adjustable outdoor air  
damper that can set in a fixed position to control the  
amount of outdoor air that is brought into the building  
for ventilation. As long as the supply fan is operative,  
ventilation air will be brought into the building. To  
adjust the damper:  
In this mode the Simplicity Elite control monitors the  
CO2 level in the conditioned space. The Simplicity  
Elite control modulates the outdoor air damper beyond  
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” in order  
to keep the CO2 level within +/- 100 PPM of the “IAQ  
SETPOINT”.  
In order to use this feature a CO2 sensor must be installed  
in the conditioned space and connected to “DV+” and  
the “DV-“ terminals of the P20 connector.  
Loosen the wing nut that holds the adjustment  
handle in a fixed position.  
Move the handle to the desired position.  
Tighten the wing nut to hold the handle in the  
The following parameters must be programmed to  
enable Demand Ventilation:  
desired position.  
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” – must be enabled  
using Parameter 32 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
Fixed Minimum  
The following parameters must be programmed to  
enable Fixed Minimum Ventilation:  
“ECONOMIZER INSTALLED” – must be enabled  
using Parameter 32 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” – must be  
programmed using Parameter 35 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” – must be  
programmed using Parameter 35 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
“DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) ENABLED” – must  
be enabled using Parameter 40 under the PROGRAM  
key of the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
COMFORT / DEMAND VENTILATION tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
Sequence of Operation  
“IAQ SENSOR RANGE” - must be programmed  
using Parameter 41 under the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board or under the COMFORT  
/ DEMAND VENTILATION tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
The damper will open to the programmed  
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” whenever  
the following conditions are met:  
“IAQ SETPOINT” - must be programmed using  
Parameter 42 under the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board or under the COMFORT  
/ DEMAND VENTILATION tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
The unit is in the occupied mode.  
There must be a 24-volt output from the Simplic-  
ity Elite control to the supply fan control circuit.  
The output is contained at the “FAN” terminal  
of connector P13 on the Simplicity Elite control  
board.  
“MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION” – must  
be programmed under the COMFORT / DEMAND  
VENTILATION tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
When the economizer becomes active the position  
of the dampers are controlled by the Economizer  
PI logic which could move the dampers beyond  
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”;  
however, the Economizer PI logic can never  
close the dampers less then the “ECONOMIZER  
MINIMUM POSITION”.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
90  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Definitions  
If the CO2 level in the conditioned space is  
greater then the “IAQ SETPOINT” + 100 PPM  
the outdoor air damper will open, but never more  
than the “MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER PO-  
SITION”.  
“IAQ SENSOR RANGE” –This establishes the span the  
Simplicity Elite control uses in PPM. 0 PPM would be  
equal to a 0 volts input to the Simplicity Elite control,  
“IAQ SENSOR RANGE” would be equal to 10 volts  
input to the Simplicity Elite control. The “IAQ SENSOR  
RANGE” must match the PPM range of the sensor  
installed in the conditioned space.  
If the CO2 level in the conditioned space is less  
then the “IAQ SETPOINT” - 100 PPM the out-  
door air damper will close, but never less then  
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”.  
“IAQ SETPOINT” – This is the conditioned space CO2  
level the Simplicity Elite control is trying to maintain.  
VENTILATION LOW AMBIENT MINIMUM POSITION  
RESET  
“MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION” – This  
is the maximum damper position the Simplicity Elite  
control will allow the damper to open while in a Demand  
Ventilation mode no matter how great a differential is  
between the conditioned space CO2 level and the “IAQ  
SETPOINT”.  
This feature allows the control to reset the minimum  
ventilation set point to a lower value when the outdoor  
temperature is cold. This assists in keeper the supply air  
temperature from dropping because of a fixed ventilation  
requirement when the outdoor temperature drops.  
Sequence of Operation  
To use this feature the following parameters need to be  
programmed:  
The damper will open to the programmed  
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” whenever  
the following conditions are met:  
“LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT” – this  
parameter is programmed under the ECONOMIZER/  
EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC software  
package.  
The unit is in the occupied mode.  
There must be a 24-volt output from the Simplic-  
ity Elite control to the supply fan control circuit.  
The output is contained at the “FAN” terminal  
of connector P13 on the Simplicity Elite control  
board.  
“LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM  
POSITION” – this parameter is programmed under  
the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity  
PC software package.  
5
When the economizer becomes active the position  
of the dampers are controlled by the Economizer  
PI logic which could move the dampers beyond  
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”;  
however, the Economizer PI logic can never  
close the dampers less then the “ECONOMIZER  
MINIMUM POSITION”.  
Sequence of Operation  
When “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT”  
is programmed to 0 the feature is disabled. To  
use this feature programmed this parameter to the  
outdoor temperature at which you want the Simplicity  
Elite control to switch to the “LOW AMBIENT  
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”. This  
parameter can be programmed between 0 and 60.0° F.  
If the above criteria are met, the Simplicity Elite control  
will then monitor the CO2 level in the conditioned space  
and vary the position of the outdoor air damper between  
the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION” and the  
“MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION” based  
on the following:  
The parameter “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER  
MINIMUM POSITION” needs to be programmed to the  
minimum position of the damper when the temperature  
is below the “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER  
SETPOINT”. This parameter can be programmed  
between 0 and 99%. It would normally be programmed  
less then the “ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”  
parameter.  
The Simplicity Elite control will try to maintain  
the CO2 level in the conditioned space to +/- 100  
PPM of the “IAQ SETPOINT”.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
91  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
When the outdoor temperature is equal to or less than  
the “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT” the  
Simplicity Elite control will set the minimum position  
of the outdoor damper to the programmed “LOW  
AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”  
setting.  
“ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST  
FAN TO TURN OFF” – must be programmed  
using Parameter 49 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
When the outdoor temperature is 1.0° F or more above  
the “LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT” the  
Simplicity Control will set the minimum position of the  
outdoor damper to the programmed “ECONOMIZER  
MINIMUM POSITION” setting.  
Sequence of Operation  
When the output to the economizer damper is equal  
to or greater then the “ECONOMIZER DAMPER  
POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON” the  
Simplicity Elite control closes the output to the exhaust  
fan motor. The output is at the “EXH” terminal of the  
P13 connector.  
EXHAUST FAN OPERATION  
The Simplicity Elite control can be configured for the  
following types of exhaust fan operation:  
When the output to the economizer damper is equal to  
or less then the “ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION  
FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN OFF” the Simplicity  
Elite control open the output to the exhaust fan motor.  
On/Off Control Based On Outdoor Damper Posi-  
tion.  
On/Off Control Based On Building Pressure.  
The minimum run time is 10 seconds and the minimum  
off time is 60 seconds.  
Modulating Damper with Fixed Speed Ex-  
haust.  
On/Off Control Based on Building Pressure  
Modulating Exhaust with a VFD.  
On/Off Control Based on Outdoor Damper Posi-  
tion  
This exhaust option uses a standard motor without any  
type of speed control and a barometric damper.  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Elite control:  
This exhaust option uses a standard motor without any  
type of speed control and a barometric damper.  
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned  
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Elite control:  
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned  
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
“BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR  
INSTALLED” – must be turned on using Parameter 85  
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control  
board or under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab  
in the Simplicity PC software package.  
“ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR  
EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON” – must be programmed  
using Parameter 48 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
“BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” must be  
programmed using Parameter 31 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
92  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Sequence of Operation  
“EXHAUSTDAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUSTFAN  
TO TURN OFF” must be programmed using Parameter  
47 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite  
control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
When the building static pressure is 0.015” WC or more  
above the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the  
Simplicity Elite control closes the output to the exhaust  
fan motor. The output is at the “EXH” terminal of the  
P13 connector.  
Sequence of Operation  
When the building static pressure is 0.015” WC or more  
below the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the  
Simplicity Elite control opens the output to the exhaust  
fan motor.  
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or more  
above the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the  
Simplicity Elite control sends a 2 to 10 volt DC signal to  
open the exhaust damper. The output is at the “EXD+”  
and “EXD-“ terminals at the P14 connector.  
The minimum run time is 10 seconds and the minimum  
off time is 60 seconds.  
Modulating Damper with Fixed Speed Exhaust  
When the exhaust damper position is equal to or greater  
than the “EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR  
EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON” the Simplicity Elite  
control turns on the exhaust fan. The output is at the  
“EXH” terminal of the P13 connector.  
This exhaust option uses a standard motor without any  
type of speed control and a modulating damper.  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Elite control:  
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or more  
below the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the  
Simplicity Elite control lowers the 2 – 10 volt DC output  
to the exhaust damper to close the damper.  
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned  
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
When the exhaust damper position is equal to or less  
than the “EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR  
EXHAUST FAN TO TURN OFF” the Simplicity Elite  
control turns on the exhaust fan.  
5
“BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR  
INSTALLED” – must be turned on using Parameter 85  
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control  
board or under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab  
in the Simplicity PC software package.  
The minimum run time is 20 seconds and the minimum  
off time is 60 seconds.  
Modulating Exhaust with a VFD  
“BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” must be  
programmed using Parameter 31 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
This exhaust option uses a Variable Frequency Drive  
(VFD) and a barometric damper.  
The following System Parameters must be programmed  
through the Simplicity Elite control:  
“MODULATING POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED”  
must be turned on using Parameter 44 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control board  
or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED” – must be turned  
on using Parameter 43 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
“EXHAUSTDAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUSTFAN  
TO TURN ON” must be programmed using Parameter  
46 under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite  
control board or under the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
93  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
“BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR  
INSTALLED” – must be turned on using Parameter 85  
under the PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control  
board or under the EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION tab  
in the Simplicity PC software package.  
“PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE ENABLE” – must be  
enabled using the SYSTEM OPTIONS tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (hours of day)”  
– must be programmed using the SYSTEM OPTIONS  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
“BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” must be  
programmed using Parameter 31 under the PROGRAM  
key on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
“PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (minutes of day)”  
– must be programmed using the SYSTEM OPTIONS  
tab in the Simplicity PC software package.  
“EXHAUST VFD INSTALLED” must be turned  
on using Parameter 45 under the PROGRAM key  
on the Simplicity Elite control board or under the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab in the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
Criteria for Operation  
The feature will only work when the internal  
scheduling feature is being used to determine  
occupied and unoccupied periods.  
Sequence of Operation  
The feature will only work on a day that has a  
occupied period scheduled.  
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or more  
above the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT” the  
Simplicity Elite control sends a 2 to 10 volt DC signal  
to Exhaust Fan VFD, the output is at the “EXD+” and  
“EXD-“ terminals at the P14 connector, and enables  
the VFD operation through the output at the “EXH”  
terminal of the P13 connector. When the exhaust fan  
first comes on it will operate at the “Output Frequency  
Low Limit” that is programmed into the Exhaust  
Van VFD, regardless of the voltage output from the  
Simplicity Elite control.  
Sequence of Operation  
The programmed “PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE  
TIME” is length of the pre-purge prior to the  
start of the occupancy period. For example if  
the “PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (hours  
of day)” is set for 1, the “PRE-OCCUPANCY  
PURGE TIME (minutes of day)” is set to 30 and  
the occupancy start time is 8:00 AM pre-purge  
would start at 6:30 AM and operate until 8:00  
AM.  
When the building static pressure is 0.025” WC or  
more below the “BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT”  
the Simplicity Elite control lowers the 2 – 10 volt DC  
output to the Exhaust Fan VFD. When the output is  
equal to or below 2 volts, the Exhaust Fan VFD enable  
input is removed.  
While in the pre-purge mode the Simplicity Elite  
control will turn on the fan and modulate the  
outdoor air damper to 100% as long as the supply  
air temperature is between 45.0° F and 90.0° F.  
If the supply air temperature drops below 45.0° F  
the control will modulate the outdoor air damper  
closed until the supply air temperature rises above  
50.0° F.  
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE  
This feature allows the blower to come on and the  
economizer damper to open during the unoccupied  
period to purge the air within the conditioned space.  
If the supply air temperature rises above 90.0° F  
the control will modulate the outdoor air damper  
closed unit the supply air temperature falls below  
85.0° F.  
In order to use this feature the following parameters  
must be programmed:  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
94  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ENERGY RECOVERY VENTILATOR  
OUTDOOR AIR HEATING LOCKOUT  
If the unit has an Energy Recovery Ventilator installed  
the exhaust fan needs to operate any time the supply fan  
is energized. This feature can be programmed to only  
occur in the occupied mode or in both the occupied and  
unoccupied mode.  
This feature prevents the Simplicity Elite control  
from operating in the heating mode when the outdoor  
temperature is above this set point.  
The set point for this feature is programmed through  
the following parameter:  
The following parameters must be programmed to use  
this feature:  
“OUTDOOR AIR TEMP HEATING LOCKOUT” – is  
programmed using the HEATING SETUP tab in the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
“ERV ENABLED” – must be enabled using the  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab of the Simplicity PC  
software package.  
HOT GAS BYPASS  
If you want this feature to operate in the unoccupied  
mode the following parameter must be enabled.  
Hot gas by pass is used to inject discharge gas into the  
expansion valve distributor to artificially place a load on  
the evaporator coil under a light load condition. This is  
done to raise the suction pressure to keep the saturation  
temperature of the refrigerant high enough to prevent  
icing of the coil. An auxiliary contact on the condenser  
fan, 7M- contactor, energizes the hot gas bypass valve  
whenever the contactor is energized. The hot gas valve  
monitors the suction pressure and will modulate to keep  
the suction pressure above 55 PSIG.  
“ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLED”- must be  
enabled using the ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST tab of  
the Simplicity PC software package.  
Sequence of Operation  
In the occupied mode, anytime the supply fan is  
energized the exhaust fan will also be turned on.  
All VAV units have a hot gas valve installed in the  
number 1 compressor system. Hot gas is optional  
on CV units. If the lead/lag option is enabled the  
Simplicity Elite control needs to know the hot gas  
option is installed. This is done through the following  
programming parameter.  
If “ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLED” is enabled  
the exhaust fan will operate in either the occupied or  
unoccupied mode when the supply fan is energized.  
5
If the unit has a Exhaust Fan VFD, the output voltage  
to the Exhaust Fan VFD will be the same as the voltage  
output to the supply fan VFD.  
“HOT GAS BY PASS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR #  
1” - must be turned on using Parameter 79 under the  
PROGRAM key on the Simplicity Elite control board  
or under the COOLING SETUP tab of the Simplicity  
PC software.  
LOW VOLTAGE PROTECTION  
The Simplicity Elite control monitors the 24 VAC  
low voltage level. Before the Simplicity Elite control  
energizes a binary output to a contactor, it checks this  
voltage level. If the voltage is equal to or less than  
19.2 volts the control will not energize the output and  
will flash an Alarm Code 35. If the voltage rises above  
19.2 volts the control will close the output and resume  
normal operation.  
SPACE TEMPERATURE ALARM  
When this feature is enabled, the Simplicity Elite  
control monitors the space temperature. When the  
space temperature continues to trend above or below  
the programmed set point and the programmed time  
has expired, the Simplicity Elite control will declare a  
Space Temperature Alarm.  
If the voltage drops below 16 volts with binary outputs  
already energized, the control will open all the binary  
outputs to the contactors and flash an Alarm Code 35.  
If the voltage rises above 19.2 volts the Simplicity Elite  
control will resume normal operation.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
95  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SAT ALARM FOR HEATING  
The following parameters must be programmed:  
“SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”- must  
be programmed under SYSTEM OPTIONS tab of the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
When this feature is turned on, the Simplicity Elite  
control monitors the supply air temperature in the  
heating mode and will generate an alarm if the supply air  
temperature goes below the set point, and if conditions  
are met, modifies the amount of ventilation air to keep  
the supply air temperature above this set point when all  
the heating stages are energized. This feature can only  
be used on unit operating in the VAV mode.  
“SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME”- must  
be programmed under SYSTEM OPTIONS tab of the  
Simplicity PC software package.  
Sequence of Operation  
In order to use this feature the following parameter must  
be programmed:  
To enable this feature “SPACE TEMP TREND-  
ING ALARM TEMP” must be set at other then  
zero.  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR  
HEATING” – must be set under the HEATING SETUP  
tab of the Simplicity PC software package.  
Set “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”  
to the number of degrees above or below the  
space temperature that you want temperature  
trending to begin. The range is 1.0° F to 25.0° F  
in 1.0° F increments.  
If “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR HEATING” is set to zero this feature is dis-  
abled. If not set to zero, then the setting becomes  
the alarm set point.  
To enable this feature “SPACE TEMP TREND-  
ING ALARM TIME” must be set at other then  
zero.  
Set “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR HEATING” to the temperature you want  
to use for the Alarm set point. The range is 1.0°  
F to 120.0° F in 1.0° F increments.  
Set “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME”  
to the amount of time the space temperature must  
be trending above or below the “SPACE TEMP  
TRENDING ALARM TEMP” before a Space  
Temperature Alarm will be initiated. The range  
is 1 to 120 minutes in 1 minute increments.  
Sequence of Operation  
Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Heating”  
Alarm  
The unit must have been in a given operating  
mode for 10 minutes before trending will be-  
gin.  
The control will initiate a “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
ALARM FOR HEATING” and flash an Alarm  
Code 39 if the following conditions are met:  
Every time the trend moves towards the space  
temperature set point the “SPACE TEMP  
TRENDING ALARM TIME” will reset to zero  
– All the stages of heating have been on for 10  
or more minutes.  
– The supply air temperature is 20 degrees  
below the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM  
SETPOINT FOR HEATING” set point for 10  
minutes.  
– The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more cooler  
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM  
SETPOINT FOR HEATING” set point.  
– The outdoor air damper is not open more than  
20%  
When the temperature is above or below the  
“SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”  
and the trend continues to be away from the space  
temperature and the “SPACE TEMP TRENDING  
ALARM TIME” has expired, the Simplicity Elite  
control will declare a “SPACE TEMPERATURE”  
Alarm. The Simplicity Elite control will flash an  
Alarm Code 41.  
The Simplicity Elite control will continue normal  
operation while in this fault mode.  
The Simplicity Elite control will continue to  
show the fault until the space temperature is less  
then the “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM  
TEMP”.  
In order to reset the above Alarm power to the  
unit must be cycled on and off.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
96  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SAT ALARM FOR COOLING  
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm  
When this feature is turned, on the Simplicity Elite  
control monitors the supply air temperature in the  
cooling mode and will generate an alarm if the supply air  
temperature goes above the set point, and if conditions  
are met, modifies the amount of ventilation air to keep  
the supply air temperature below this set point when all  
the cooling stages are energized. This feature can only  
be used on unit operating in the VAV mode.  
The supply air temperature must be below the  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR  
HEATING” set point and the following sequence  
of events have occurred:  
– All the stages of heating must have been on  
for 10 or more minutes.  
– The outdoor air is 20.0° F or more cooler then  
the “SUPPLY AIR TEMPALARM SETPOINT  
FOR HEATING” set point.  
In order to use this feature the following parameter must  
be programmed:  
– The economizer must be open more than  
20%.  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR  
COOLING” – must be set under the COOLING SETUP  
tab of the Simplicity PC software package.  
If the above criteria is met  
– The Simplicity Elite control will close the  
outdoor damper for ten minutes.  
– After ten minutes, the Simplicity Elite control  
will read the supply air temperature.  
– If the supply air temperature is above the  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR HEATING”, the control will keep the  
outdoor damper closed and complete the  
heating cycle.  
If “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR COOLING” is set to zero this feature is  
disabled. If not set to zero, then the setting be-  
comes the alarm set point.  
Set “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR COOLING” to the temperature you want  
to use for the alarm set point. The range is 1.0°  
F to 80.0° F in 1.0° F increments.  
The Simplicity Elite control will declare an  
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”  
Alarm and flash an Alarm Code 40.  
5
Sequence of Operation  
– If the supply air temperature is not above the  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR HEATING”.  
“Supply Air Temp Alarm Setpoint for Cooling”  
Alarm  
The Simplicity Elite control will declare  
a “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR  
HEATING” Alarm and flash an Alarm  
Code 39.  
The control will initiate a “SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
ALARM FOR COOLING” and flash an Alarm  
Code 38 if the following conditions are met:  
– After the heating cycle is completed, the Sim-  
plicity Elite control sets the outdoor damper  
to its minimum position.  
– All the stages of cooling have been on for 10  
or more minutes.  
– In order to reset the above alarms power to  
the unit must be cycled on and off.  
– The supply air temperature is 20 degrees  
above the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM  
SETPOINT FOR COOLING” set point for  
10 minutes.  
– The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more warmer  
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM  
SETPOINT FOR COOLING” set point.  
– The outdoor air damper is not open more than  
20%.  
In order to reset the above alarm power to the  
unit must be cycled on and off.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
97  
Sequence of Operation  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ALARM HISTORY  
“Economizer Minimum Position” Alarm  
The last five alarms can be view on the Simplicity Elite  
control board as follows. The sequence below gives the  
alarms from the most recent to the oldest.  
The supply air temperature must be above the  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR  
COOLING” set point and the following sequence  
of events have occurred:  
Alarm 1 – The most recent alarm can be viewed  
under Parameter 72 using the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board.  
– All the stages of cooling must have been on  
for 10 or more minutes.  
– The outdoor air is 20.0° F or more warmer  
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM  
SETPOINT FOR COOLING” set point.  
– The economizer must be open more than  
20%.  
Alarm 2 – The next alarm in sequence can be viewed  
under Parameter 73 using the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board.  
Alarm 3 - The next alarm in sequence can be viewed  
under Parameter 74 using the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board.  
If the above criteria is met:  
– The Simplicity Elite control will close the  
outdoor damper for ten minutes.  
Alarm 4 - The next alarm in sequence can be viewed  
under Parameter 75 using the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board.  
– After ten minutes, the Simplicity Elite control  
will read the supply air temperature.  
– If the supply air temperature is below the  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR COOLING”, the control will keep the  
outdoor damper closed and complete the cool-  
ing cycle.  
Alarm 5 - The next alarm in sequence can be viewed  
under Parameter 76 using the PROGRAM key on the  
Simplicity Elite control board.  
The Simplicity Elite control will declare an  
“ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION”  
alarm and flash an Alarm Code 40.  
The above alarms can also be viewed using the  
ALARMS tab in the Simplicity PC software program.  
– If the supply air temperature is not below the  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT  
FOR COOLING”.  
The Simplicity Elite control will declare a  
“SUPPLY AIR TEMPALARM SETPOINT  
FOR COOLING” alarm and flash an  
Alarm Code 38.  
– After the cooling cycle is completed, the Sim-  
plicity Elite control sets the outdoor damper  
to its minimum position.  
– In order to reset the above alarms power to  
the unit must be cycled on and off.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
98  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 6 – USER INTERFACE  
PROGRAM BUTTON  
There are three different methods that can be used to  
interface with the Simplicity Elite control:  
This button puts the board into the program mode. In  
the program mode, the control displays the parameter  
number of the two-digit display and the data for the  
parameter of the four-digit display.  
Program buttons and display on the Unit Control-  
ler  
Communication between the Unit Controller and  
a PC or Personal Computer using “Simplicity  
PC”.  
For example, the Occupied Cooling Setpoint is parameter  
address 10. The addresses are listed on the Parameter  
Points list. Pressing the program button once places  
the board in program mode. The two-digit display  
shows address 1 and the four-digit display shows the  
current setting for that address. To scroll up to address  
10, press the Test/Up button until address 10 appears  
on the two-digit display. Address 10 is the Occupied  
Cooling Setpoint. The factory default setting for this  
parameter is 72º F. To change this setpoint, address the  
Alarm/Change button one time. The temperature is now  
flashing and may be increased or decreased by pressing  
the Test/Up button or theAddress/Down button. When  
the desired temperature has been selected, pressing the  
Alarm/Change button accepts and stores the change.  
Communication between the Unit Controller and  
a network  
This section of the manual will explain how each of  
these interface method is employed.  
UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE  
Four buttons located on the control board allow for  
viewing and access to setpoints, alarms, functions,  
etc. The buttons are used in conjunction with the two  
numerical character displays located on the board.  
The character display is a convenient way to access  
information on the controller when a computer is not  
available. Three of the buttons have multiple functions.  
The button functions are discussed in detail below.  
PROGRAM  
TEST/UP  
2 CHARACTER DISPLAY  
6
RS 485 PORT  
4 CHARACTER DISPLAY  
RS 485 PORT  
ADDRESS/DOWN  
LD13013  
ALARM/CHANGE  
LED  
FIG. 6-1 – UNIT CONTROLLER INTERFACE  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
99  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ALARM/CHANGE  
If the program button is pushed while in the program  
mode, the control will exit the program mode and store  
any changed data even if the operator failed to press the  
Alarm/Change button to accept any changes.  
When this button is pressed and released one time within  
five-seconds, it automatically scrolls through the five  
alarms held in memory. The first alarm displayed is the  
latest and the last displayed is the oldest.  
TEST/UP BUTTON  
When this button is pressed and released twice within  
five-seconds, it clears all alarms in memory.  
When not in the program mode, if the Test/Up button  
is pushed and released once within five seconds, the  
control skips any short cycle delays for one cycle. This  
is a useful aid for the technician servicing the system  
without having to wait for delays to time out.  
When in the program mode and with a parameter  
selected, this button when pressed once causes the data  
value for that parameter to begin flashing. At this point  
the data value can be increased or decreased using the  
Test/Up and Address/Down buttons. When pressed  
again the current data setting is accepted and stored.  
If this button is pressed and released twice within five-  
seconds a lock-out is released. This serves the same  
function as temporally breaking the 24 VAC circuit to  
the Unit Controller.  
CHARACTER DISPLAY ADDRESSES & CODES  
Table 6-2 shows the address for each control function  
as well as the unit of measurement for that function, the  
available range of adjustment and the factory setting as  
the unit left the factory.  
When in the program mode this button scrolls up  
through the parameter addresses. See the Parameter  
Points list to identify the desired parameter. Parameters  
are items that can be viewed and changed in the control  
such as setpoints, year, date, time, time delays, etc.  
Refer to Section 7 “Parameter Descriptions and  
Options” for a description of each of the parameters  
listed in Table 6-1.  
ADDRESS/DOWN BUTTON  
When in the program mode this button scrolls down  
through the parameter addresses.  
This button is also used to set the controller up on a  
network. When wired to a network through the RS-485  
terminals on the board, pushing this button once when  
not in the program mode causes the control to scan the  
communication bus. The control automatically locates  
the first vacant communications address and changes its  
address to that address. It will then display the address  
on the display for two seconds. The controller is then  
connected to the network.  
When connected to a network, pressing the button twice  
within five-seconds causes the network address to be  
displayed for two seconds.  
Pressing this button three times within five-seconds  
resets the network address to one.  
100  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST  
ADDRESS  
DESCRIPTION  
NUMBER  
RANGE OF  
ADJUSTMENT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0-30  
CURRENT  
SETTING  
OFF  
30  
UNITS OF ADJUSTMENT  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
RUN TEST  
PARAMETER BIT  
SECONDS  
HEAT FAN ON DELAY  
HEAT FAN OFF DELAY  
COOL FAN ON DELAY  
COOL FAN OFF DELAY  
ADDRESS  
SECONDS  
0-255  
60  
SECONDS  
0-30  
0
SECONDS  
0-255  
30  
DATA  
1-250  
1
TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN WHEN STARTING  
CONSTRUCTION MODE  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0-240  
OFF  
OFF  
60  
9
UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME PERIOD  
DATA MINUTES  
0 = DISABLED  
45º - 99º  
MINUTES  
72º  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
CV OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT  
CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT  
CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT  
CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING ENABLE  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING ENABLED  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT  
HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED  
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR  
SETPOINT  
DEGREES F  
DEGREES F  
45º - 99º  
68º  
DEGREES F  
45º - 99º  
85º  
DEGREES F  
45º - 99º  
60º  
PARAMETER BIT  
DEGREES F  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
40º - 65º  
ON  
50º  
PARAMETER BIT  
DEGREES F  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
100º - 180º  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
ON  
135º  
OFF  
PARAMETER BIT  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
DEGREES F  
80º - 180º  
80º - 180º  
120º  
150º  
OFF  
OFF  
60º  
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR  
SETPOINT  
DEGREES F  
HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE  
ACTING  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
DEGREES F  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
40º - 70º  
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLE FOR THIRD  
PARTY BAS  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT  
DEGREES F  
40º - 70º  
55º  
25  
26  
27  
28  
VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT  
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED  
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT  
MORNING WARM-UP ENABLE  
DEGREES F  
40º - 85º  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
40º - 85º  
72º  
OFF  
68º  
6
PARAMETER BIT  
DEGREES F  
PARAMETER BIT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
ON  
MORNING WARM-UP / VAV RETURN AIR TEMP  
SETPOINT  
29  
30  
31  
DEGREES F  
50º - 85º  
0.000 - 5.000  
-.250 -.250  
70º  
1.500  
0.1  
PRESSURE - INCHES OF  
H2O  
DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT  
PRESSURE - INCHES OF  
H2O  
BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT  
32  
33  
34  
35  
ECONOMIZER INSTALLED  
PARAMETER BIT  
DEGREES F  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
40º - 65º  
ON  
55º  
ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT  
ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT  
ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION  
DEGREES F  
40º - 65º  
50º  
PERCENT  
0 - 100%  
20%  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
101  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST (CONT.)  
ADDRESS  
DESCRIPTION  
NUMBER  
RANGE OF  
ADJUSTMENT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
10 - 50  
CURRENT  
SETTING  
OFF  
UNITS OF ADJUSTMENT  
36  
37  
38  
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED  
PARAMETER BIT  
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT BTUS PER POUND  
27  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED  
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP ENABLE  
SETPOINT  
PARAMETER BIT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
OFF  
39  
DEGREES F  
40º - 80º  
55º  
40  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) ENABLED  
IAQ SENSOR RANGE  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARTS PER MILLION  
PARTS PER MILLION  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER  
POSITION  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 - 5000 PPM  
OFF  
2000  
1000  
ON  
IAQ SETPOINT  
0 - 5000 PPM  
POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
MODULATING POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED  
EXHAUST VFD INSTALLED  
OFF  
OFF  
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN  
TO TURN ON (MODULATING ONLY)  
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN  
TO TURN OFF  
46  
47  
48  
49  
0 - 100%  
0 - 100%  
0 - 100%  
0 - 100%  
80%  
20%  
60%  
20%  
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER  
POSITION  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST  
FAN TO TURN ON (NON-MODULATING ONLY)  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST  
FAN TO TURN OFF (MODULATING ONLY)  
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER  
POSITION  
PERCENT OF ECONOMIZER  
POSITION  
0 = CLOSED,  
0 = CLOSED,  
1 = OPEN  
50  
51  
52  
APS DATA  
OPEN  
OFF  
1 = OPEN  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INSTALLED  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH DATA  
PARAMETER BIT  
0 = CLOSED,  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OPEN,  
OPEN  
1 = OPEN  
1 = CLOSED  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
53  
54  
COOLING MODE OPERATION ENABLE  
HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION  
CONTINUOUS INDOOR FAN OPERATION WITH  
SENSOR  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
ON  
ON  
55  
PARAMETER BIT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
ON  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
65  
66  
67  
68  
69  
70  
71  
SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE  
METRIC OPERATION  
THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER ENABLED  
YEAR  
DEGREES F  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
YEAR (BCD)  
MONTH  
-5º F - 5º F  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
00 - 99  
0º F  
OFF  
OFF  
4
1
MONTH  
1 - 12  
DAY OF MONTH  
DAY OF MONTH  
DAY OF WEEK  
HOURS  
1 - 31  
1
DAY OF WEEK  
1 - 7  
1
HOUR  
0 - 23  
0
MINUTE  
MINUTES  
0 - 59  
0
SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
DEGREES F  
DEGREES F  
DEGREES F  
DEGREES F  
HUMIDITY  
-40º - 180º  
-40º - 180º  
-40º - 180º  
-40º - 180º  
0% - 100%  
0% - 100%  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0
RETURN AIR TEMP  
0
OUTSIDE AIR TEMP  
0
SPACE TEMP  
0
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY  
OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLE  
0
HUMIDITY  
0
PARAMETER BIT  
OFF  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
102  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-1 - PARAMETER POINTS LIST (CONT.)  
ADDRESS  
DESCRIPTION  
NUMBER  
RANGE OF  
ADJUSTMENT  
CURRENT  
SETTING  
UNITS OF ADJUSTMENT  
DATA - 5 CHARACTERS  
READ ONLY FLAG  
72/73/74/  
ALARM ARRAY  
75/76  
0 - 255  
0
CV = 0  
VAV = 1  
77  
VAV / CV SELECTION  
0
78  
79  
80  
HOT GAS REHEAT  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
2 - 4  
OFF  
OFF  
2
HOT GAS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR # 1  
COMPRESSORS AVAILABLE FOR COOLING  
0 - 3  
81  
82  
83  
STAGES OF HEAT AVAILABLE  
DUCT STATIC READING  
PARAMETER BIT  
2
0 = DISABLED  
PRESSURE - INCHES OF  
H2O  
0.000 - 5.000  
0.000 - 5.000  
0000  
0000  
PRESSURE - INCHES OF  
H2O  
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE  
LOW AMBIENT KIT INSTALLED  
84  
85  
86  
87  
PARAMETER BIT  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
0 = OFF, 1 = ON  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
OFF  
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR INSTALLED PARAMETER BIT  
ERV INSTALLED  
PARAMETER BIT  
PARAMETER BIT  
PRESSURE - INCHES OF  
H2O  
ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLE  
88  
DUCT STATIC SHUTDOWN SETPOINT  
0.000 - 5.000  
4.500  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
103  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
COMMUNICATION USING SIMPLICITY PC  
The recommended method to use for set up and  
troubleshooting is to connect the Simplicity Control to a  
PC or Personal Computer with “Simplicity PC” software  
installed. “Simplicity PC” software is available  
through the York UPG web site. The instructions for  
downloading the software are as follows:  
Simplicity PC Download  
1. On the internet connect to YorkUPG.Com  
2. Left
 
click on Dealers / Distributors  
LD13036  
104  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
3. Left
 
click on software  
LD13037  
Left click on Software  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
105  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
4. Left click on Simplicity Software and follow the  
directions for downloading the program into your  
computer.  
USB Adapter Drive - Simplicity Pocket PC  
6. In addition to the software an adapter and cable  
will be required to connect to the Unit Controller.  
The following are available through either Source  
1 Parts or Baltimore Parts:  
5. Two additional programs are available for down-  
loading. If you are running the “Simplicity PC”  
software on a Pocket PC you must also download  
Simplicity Pocket PC. Left click on Simplicity  
Pocket PC and follow the directions for download-  
ing the program into your Pocket PC.  
FREEnet Serial Adapter – Part Number 031-  
01966-000  
If you are going to connect the Unit Controller to  
your computer through a USB port you will also  
have to download the USB driver. To do that left  
click on FREE net USBAdapter Driver and follow  
the directions for downloading the program into  
your PC.  
FREEnet USB Adapter – Part Number 031-  
01967-000  
Cable – Part Number 025-38682-000  
106  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
7. The FREEnet USBAdapter comes with a standard  
USB cable. The “A” end plugs into the computer  
and the “B” end into the FREEnet USB Adapter.  
FREEnet Serial  
CABLE WIRE COLOR  
ADAPTER TERMINAL  
BOARD MARKING  
GND  
GREEN  
BROWN  
WHITE  
TDA(-)  
8. The FREEnet SerialAdapter comes with a standard  
9-pin Serial Extension Cable. It has a computer  
standard 9-pin male connector to plug into the  
adapter and the same style 9-pin female connec-  
tor to plug into the computer. If the computer  
connections are the older 25-pin connector, a 25-  
pin female to 9-pin male cable or adapter will be  
needed.  
TDB (+)  
JUMPER  
JUMPER  
TDB(+) TO RDB(+)  
TDA(-) TO RDA(-)  
10. Connect the other end of the cable to the RS-485  
P5 connector on the Unit Controller.  
Establishing Communication  
The FREEnet Serial Adapter requires two AAA  
batteries for power. There is an “OFF/ON” switch  
on the side of the adapter that needs to be turned on  
for operation. When not in use turn off the battery  
to extend its life.  
1 After installing the Simplicity PC software on the  
computer, the Simplicity PC icon will appear on  
the desktop. Double-click on the Simplicity icon  
to open the Simplicity window.  
9. The above cable connects between the FREEnet  
USB or FREEnet Serial Adapter to the Unit Con-  
troller. The following table should be used to  
connect the cable to each of the adapters.  
LD13039  
FREEnet USB  
ADAPTER TERMINAL  
BOARD MARKING  
CABLE WIRE COLOR  
Double click on Simplicity PC icon  
GREEN  
BROWN  
WHITE  
GND  
TDA(-)  
TDB (+)  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
107  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
2. Click on the “Add” button and a dialog box will  
appear as shown below.  
LD13040  
Left click on Add button  
3. In the “Connection Type” dialog box, select “Se-  
rial/USB Direct Connection”. Click on the “Port  
Number” pull down box and select the computer  
port on the computer that the network is connected  
to. The port number in the connection box will  
vary depending upon the particular computer used  
and what port connection it uses or has available.  
You can also use the “Connection Name” box to  
identify the unit.  
3a. Select Serial/USB  
direct Connection  
3b. Select proper  
Port Number  
LD13041  
4. Click Add button  
108  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
4. In the dialog box, click the “Add” button. The  
“Add Connection” dialog box will close and the  
main Simplicity window will appear. In the left  
pane of the main screen is a tree. Under “My  
Connections”, the name of the device installed in  
the computer port connecting the computer to the  
simplicity network will appear. The actual name  
of the device will depend upon what it was named  
when it was set up.  
5. Left Click on Scan  
LD13042  
5. Click on the “Scan” button. The software will find  
all Simplicity devices connected to the network.  
The devices will appear in the tree under the name  
of the connection device. The names of the devices  
will depend upon what they were named when set  
up on the network.  
6. Move the cursor to the small box next to the left  
of the device name and left click. The software  
will find all Simplicity devices connected to the  
network. The devices will appear in the tree under  
the name of the connection device. The names  
of the devices will depend upon what they were  
named when set up on the network.  
6
LD13040  
7. Left click on desired Simplicity Device.  
6. Left click to expand tree  
7. Left-click on the particular Simplicity device de-  
sired.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
109  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
8. The right hand side of the screen fills with a series  
of tabs. The tabs allow you to access, read, and  
change settings for that device. Click on the tab  
that corresponds to the information you wish to  
access.  
LD13043  
110  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SIMPLICITY PC DATA SCREENS  
The following pages identify the data contained in each  
of the tabs. Move the cursor to the tab and left click to  
open.  
DEVICE NAMES  
LD13015  
EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION  
6
LD13016  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
111  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SENSOR READINGS  
LD13017  
112  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ECONOMIZER/EXHAUST  
LD13018  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
113  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
FANS  
LD13019  
114  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
COOLING SETUP  
6
LD13020  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
115  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
COOLING STATUS  
LD13021  
116  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
HEATING SETUP  
6
LD13022  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
117  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
HEATING STATUS  
LD13023  
118  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SYSTEM OPTIONS  
LD13024  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
119  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
OUTPUTS/STATUS  
LD13025  
120  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
INPUTS  
LD13014  
COMFORT/DEMAND VENTILATION  
6
LD13026  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
121  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
GRAPHIC  
LD13027  
CLOCK  
LD13028  
122  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Weekly Schedule  
days. When both the Occupied and Unoccupied times  
are programmed to 12:00 AM, that period is disabled.  
If all the times are programmed to 12:00 AM, the unit  
will operate 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.  
The weekly schedule can only be programmed using  
the Simplicity PC software under the WEEKLY  
SCHEDULE SETTINGS tab. The weekly schedule has  
two Occupied/Unoccupied times for each of the seven  
WEEKLY SCHEDULE SETTINGS  
LD13029  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
123  
User Interface Control Center  
Holiday Schedule  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
month and year calendar will appear. Use the cursor to  
select the year, month, and day you want the holiday  
schedule to start. Use the up and down arrow key to  
select the time you want the holiday schedule to start.  
Finally select the number of days you want the holiday  
schedule to be active.  
The holiday schedule can only be programmed using  
the Simplicity PC software under the HOLIDAY  
SCHEDULE tab. There are 20 holiday schedules. To  
program a holiday schedule left click on the box next  
to the holiday event you want to program. Click on  
the down arrow key to set the start date, the current  
HOLIDAY SCHEDULE  
LD13030  
124  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ALARMS  
LD13031  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
125  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
REVISING SETTINGS  
To change a set point move the curser to the value you  
want to change and left click and highlight the item.  
Left click to highlight  
Double click to open  
change screen  
LD13032  
126  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
To open the change screen double left click.  
The screen will show the current value and the  
acceptable range. Us the numeric key pad to enter the  
revised setting. Left click on “Update” and the value  
will be change at the Unit Controller.  
6
LD13033  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
127  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
To change a value move the curser to the value you want  
to change and left click and highlight the item.  
Left click to highlight  
Double click to open  
change screen  
LD13034  
128  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
The screen will show the current value and option.  
Move the curser and left click on the option you want  
to turn on. Left click on “Update” and the value will  
be change at the Unit Controller.  
LD13035  
6
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
129  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP  
Writing to any register not in this list  
may cause erratic operation  
This product is not designed to accept  
continuous writes to data stored in  
long term memory. It is recommended  
that no stored value be changed more  
often than an average of once per  
hour. Changing data more often risks  
damaging the ability of the control to  
store new data for the full life of the  
product.  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
20  
VALUE VALUE  
00 H  
00 L  
01 H  
0 H  
0 L  
1 H  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
0
NA  
255  
-
DEVICE ID = 20 FOR ELITE  
-
DEVICE SOFTWARE REVISION  
54  
-
OPTION BYTE #1  
BITS 1 AND 0 = 0,0 RESPECTIVELY THERE ARE 0 STAGES OF  
HEAT; 0,1 = 1 STAGE; 1,0 = 2 STAGES; 1,1 = 3 STAGES  
0
1
2
1 = HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION  
1 = TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN WHEN STARTING HEAT  
1 = COOLING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION  
1 = ECONOMIZER LOADING ACTIVE  
3
4
5
6
1 = SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLED  
NA  
7
01 L  
02 H  
02 L  
03 H  
03 L  
04 L  
05 H  
05 L  
06 H  
06 L  
07 H  
07 L  
1 L  
2 H  
2 L  
3 H  
3 L  
4 L  
5 H  
5 L  
6 H  
6 L  
7 H  
7 L  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
30  
60  
0
NA  
0
NA  
30  
ACTIVE ALARM  
FAN ON DELAY FOR HEAT (SECONDS)  
0
255  
30  
FAN OFF DELAY FOR HEAT (SECONDS)  
0
FAN ON DELAY FOR COOL (SECONDS)  
30  
3
0
255  
10  
FAN OFF DELAY FOR COOL (SECONDS)  
1
MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR COMPRESSORS (MINUTES)  
HEATING #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH BYTE)  
HEATING #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)  
HEATING #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH BYTE)  
HEATING #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)  
HEATING #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH BYTE)  
HEATING #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)  
REGISTERS 8 - 20 STORE THE UNIT NAME. WHEN WRITTEN,  
ALL 13 REGISTERS (AT 2 BYTES PER REGISTER) SHOULD BE  
WRITTEN. THE FORMAT IS ASCII. CHARACTER #1 IS IN 8 H.  
CHARACTER #2 IS IN 8 L. CHARACTER #3 IS IN 9 H, AND SO ON.  
INPUT STATUS BYTE #1  
0
0
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
08 H - 14 L 8 H - 20 L  
NA  
15 H  
21 H  
NA  
0
-
-
-
1 = Y1 ON (COOLING 1ST STAGE)  
1
1 = Y2 ON (COOLING 2ND STAGE)  
2
1 = Y3 ON (COOLING 3RD STAGE)  
3
1 = Y4 ON (COOLING 4TH STAGE)  
4
1 = W1 ON (HEATING 1ST STAGE)  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
130  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
5
6
1 = W2 ON (HEATING 2ND STAGE)  
1 = W3 ON (HEATING 3RD STAGE)  
1 = G ON (INDOOR FAN)  
INPUT STATUS BYTE #2  
1 = HPS1 CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)  
1 = HPS2 CLOSED  
7
15 L  
21 L  
NA  
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
1
2
1 = HPS3 CLOSED  
3
1 = HPS4 CLOSED  
4
1 = LPS1 CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)  
1 = LPS2 CLOSED  
5
6
1 = LPS3 CLOSED  
7
1 = LPS4 CLOSED  
16 H  
16 L  
17 L  
17 H  
22 H  
22 L  
23 H  
23 L  
NA  
0
INPUT STATUS BYTE #3  
1 = C1 OVERLOAD CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)  
1 = C2 OVERLOAD CLOSED  
1 = C3 OVERLOAD CLOSED  
1 = C4 OVERLOAD CLOSED  
1 = PURGE SWITCH CLOSED (ACTIVE)  
1 = OCC INPUT ON  
1
2
3
4
5
6
NA  
7
1 = DIRTY FILTER CLOSED (DIRTY CONDITION)  
INPUT STATUS BYTE #4  
NA  
0
1 = GAS VALVE #1 ON  
1
1 = GAS VALVE #2 ON  
2
1 = GAS VALVE #3 ON  
3
1 = LIMIT #1 CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)  
1 = LIMIT #2 CLOSED  
4
5
1 = LIMIT #3 CLOSED  
6
NA  
6
7
NA  
NA  
0
INPUT STATUS BYTE #5  
1 = FAN OVERLOAD CLOSED (NOT TRIPPED)  
1 = FREEZE STAT CLOSED (NOT LOW TEMPERATURE)  
1 = AIR PROVING CLOSED (AIR FLOW IS SENSED)  
NA  
1
2
3
4
NA  
5
1 = VAV; 0 = CV  
6
1 = CV / VAV OUT OF RANGE (FAULT CONDITION)  
1 = LOW 24 VAC SUPPLY VOLTAGE  
INPUT STATUS BYTE #6  
7
NA  
0
1 = PROGRAM BUTTON PRESSED  
1 = TEST / UP BUTTON PRESSED  
1 = ALARMS / CHANGE BUTTON PRESSED  
1
2
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
131  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
3
4
1 = ADDRESS / DOWN BUTTON PRESSED  
NA  
5
NA  
6
NA  
7
NA  
18 H  
24 H  
NA  
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #1  
1 = COMPRESSOR #1 ON  
1 = COMPRESSOR #2 ON  
1 = COMPRESSOR #3 ON  
1 = COMPRESSOR #4 ON  
1 = CONDENSER FAN #1 ON  
1 = CONDENSER FAN #2 ON  
1 = INDOOR FAN ON  
1 = EXHAUST FAN ON  
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #2  
1 = STAGE 1 HEAT ON  
1 = STAGE 2 HEAT ON  
1 = STAGE 3 HEAT ON  
NA  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
18 L  
19 H  
19 L  
1A H  
24 L  
25 H  
25 L  
26 H  
NA  
0
-
1
2
3
4
NA  
5
NA  
6
NA  
7
NA  
NA  
0
-
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #3  
1 = COMPRESSORS OFF BECAUSE FREE COOLING IS AVAILABLE  
1
1 = COMPRESSORS OFF BECAUSE OF LOW AMBIENT  
2
1 = COMPRESSORS OFF BECAUSE SUPPLY VOLTAGE IS LOW  
3
1 = CONTROL IS IN COMFORT VENTILATION MODE  
4
1 = DISABLE CONTROL IS ACTIVE  
5
1 = ECONOMIZER IS USING FREE COOLING  
6
NA  
7
NA  
NA  
0
-
OUTPUT STATUS BYTE #4  
1 = COMPRESSOR #1 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD  
1
1 = COMPRESSOR #2 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD  
2
1 = COMPRESSOR #3 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD  
3
1 = COMPRESSOR #4 OFF BECAUSE OF ASCD  
4
NA  
5
NA  
6
NA  
7
NA  
NA  
12  
OPTION BYTE #2  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
132  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
BITS 1 AND 0 = 0,0 RESPECTIVELY THERE ARE 2 STAGES OF  
COMPRESSION; 0,1 = 3 STAGES; 1,0 = 4 STAGES; 1,1 = 4  
STAGES  
0
1
2
1 = SAT LIMIT FOR COOLING ENABLED  
1 = SAT LIMIT FOR HEATING ENABLED  
1 = HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED  
1 = HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE ACTING  
1 = REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLED FOR THIRD PARTY BAS  
1 = HOT GAS REHEAT ENABLED  
3
4
5
6
7
1A L  
1B H  
1B L  
26 L  
27 H  
27 L  
NA  
0
4
193  
8
-
-
-
-
-
-
OPTION BYTE #3  
1 = VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED  
NA  
1
2
1 = ECONOMIZER PRESENT  
3
1 = OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR PRESENT  
1 = RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR PRESENT  
1 = PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE ENABLED  
1 = DEMAND VENTILATION ENABLED  
1 = BUILDING PRESSURE SENSOR INSTALLED  
OPTION BYTE #4  
4
5
6
7
NA  
0
1 = POWER EXHAUST PRESENT  
1
1 = MODULATING POWER EXHAUST PRESENT  
1 = EXHAUST VFD PRESENT  
2
3
1 = LOW AMBIENT KIT INSTALLED  
1 = DIRTY FILTER SWITCH PRESENT  
1 = INTELLI-START OPERATION ENABLED  
1 = INDOOR FAN OPERATES WITH SPACE SENSOR PRESENT [CV]  
1 = DAYLIGHT SAVINGS TIME ENABLED  
OPTION BYTE #5  
4
5
6
7
NA  
0
6
1 = RUN TEST ENABLED  
1
1 = METER OF UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE ENABLED  
1 = METRIC DISPLAY ENABLED  
2
1 = USE THERMOSTAT OR COMMUNICATIONS FLAG FOR  
OCCUPIED SIGNAL  
3
4
1 = LEAD/LAG: EQUALIZE COMPRESSOR RUN TIME ENABLED  
1 = HOT GAS BYPASS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR #1  
1 = THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER ENABLED  
1 = MORNING WARM-UP ENABLED  
ALARM 1 - MOST RECENT ALARM.  
ALARM 2  
5
6
7
1C H  
1C L  
1D H  
1D L  
1E H  
28 H  
28 L  
29 H  
29 L  
30 H  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
ALARM 3  
ALARM 4  
ALARM 5 – OLDEST STORED ALARM.  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
133  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
COMPRESSOR #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH  
BYTE)  
1F H  
1F L  
20 H  
20 L  
21 H  
21 L  
22 H  
31 H  
31 L  
32 H  
32 L  
33 H  
33 L  
34 H  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
COMPRESSOR #1 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)  
COMPRESSOR #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH  
BYTE)  
COMPRESSOR #2 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)  
COMPRESSOR #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH  
BYTE)  
COMPRESSOR #3 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)  
COMPRESSOR #4 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, HIGH  
BYTE)  
22 L  
24 H  
26 L  
34 L  
36 H  
38 L  
NA  
NA  
NA  
0
0
1
0
1
255  
250  
NA  
COMPRESSOR #4 ACCUMULATED RUN TIME (HOURS, LOW BYTE)  
REQUESTED ADDRESS CHANGE (BUS ADDRESS)  
REQUESTED OPERATION  
NA  
NA  
1 = REQUEST FOR 1ST STAGE COOLING  
1 = REQUEST FOR 2ND STAGE COOLING  
1 = REQUEST FOR 3RD STAGE COOLING  
1 = REQUEST FOR 4TH STAGE COOLING  
1 = REQUEST FOR 1ST STAGE HEATING  
1 = REQUEST FOR 2ND STAGE HEATING  
1 = REQUEST FOR 3RD STAGE HEATING  
1 = REQUEST FOR FAN  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
REGISTERS 39 - 51 STORE THE MODEL NUMBER. WHEN  
WRITTEN, ALL 13 REGISTERS (AT 2 BYTES PER REGISTER)  
SHOULD BE WRITTEN. THE FORMAT IS ASCII. CHARACTER #1  
IS IN 39 H. CHARACTER #2 IS IN 39 L. CHARACTER #3 IS IN 40 H,  
AND SO ON.  
39 H - 51  
L
27 H - 33 L  
NA  
REGISTERS 52 - 64 STORE THE SERIAL NUMBER. WHEN  
WRITTEN, ALL 13 REGISTERS (AT 2 BYTES PER REGISTER)  
SHOULD BE WRITTEN. THE FORMAT IS ASCII. CHARACTER #1  
IS IN 52 H. CHARACTER #2 IS IN 52 L. CHARACTER #3 IS IN 53 H,  
AND SO ON.  
52 H - 64  
L
34 H - 40 L  
NA  
NA  
REDLINE/LOADSHED STATUS (5 MINUTE TIMER IS STARTED  
EACH WRITE. VALUE IS CLEARED IF TIMER IS ALLOWED TO  
FINISH.)  
41 L  
65 L  
NA  
NA  
NA  
0
1
1 = SET REDLINE OPERATION  
1 = SET LOADSHED OPERATION  
2 - 7  
BITS 2-7 UNUSED  
42 L  
43 H  
66 L  
67 H  
255  
-
CLEAR LOCKOUT STATUS  
WRITE “00” TO CLEAR ALL LOCKOUTS. ANY OTHER VALUE IS  
IGNORED. ALWAYS READS 255.  
READING THIS ADDRESS RETURNS EEPROM CHECKSUM HIGH  
BYTE  
0
255  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
134  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
READING THIS ADDRESS RETURNS EEPROM CHECKSUM LOW  
BYTE  
43 L  
67 L  
-
0
255  
44 H  
44 L  
45 H  
45 L  
46 H  
46 L  
47 H  
47 L  
48 H  
48 L  
49 H  
49 L  
4A H  
4A L  
4B H  
4B L  
4C H  
4C L  
4D H  
- 50 L  
68 H  
68 L  
4
1
0
1
99  
12  
31  
7
REAL TIME CLOCK YEAR VALUE  
REAL TIME CLOCK MONTH VALUE  
REAL TIME CLOCK DAY OF MONTH VALUE  
REAL TIME CLOCK DAY OF WEEK VALUE  
REAL TIME CLOCK HOUR VALUE  
REAL TIME CLOCK MINUTE VALUE  
OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT [CV]  
OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT [CV]  
UN-OCCUPIED COOLING SETPOINT [CV]  
UN-OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT [CV]  
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED HOUR #1  
69 H  
1
1
69 L  
1
1
70 H  
0
0
23  
59  
99  
99  
99  
99  
23  
59  
23  
59  
23  
59  
23  
59  
70 L  
0
0
71 H  
72  
68  
85  
60  
0
45  
45  
45  
45  
0
71 L  
72 H  
72 L  
73 H  
73 L  
0
0
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED MINUTE #1  
74 H  
0
0
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED HOUR #1  
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED MINUTE #1  
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED HOUR #2  
74 L  
0
0
75 H  
0
0
75 L  
0
0
DAY 1 – OCCUPIED MINUTE #2  
76 H  
0
0
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED HOUR #2  
DAY 1 – UN-OCCUPIED MINUTE #2  
76 L  
0
0
77 H - 80  
L
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
DAY 2 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)  
DAY 3 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)  
DAY 4 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)  
DAY 5 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)  
DAY 6 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)  
DAY 7 (SAME FORMAT AS DAY #1)  
81 H - 84  
L
51 H - 54 L  
55 H - 58 L  
85 H - 88  
L
59 H - 5C  
L
89 H - 92  
L
5D H  
- 60 L  
93 H - 96  
L
6
97 H - 100  
L
61 H - 64 L  
65 H  
65 L  
101 H  
101 L  
102 H  
102 L  
103 L  
104 H  
- 106 L  
107 H  
- 109 L  
110 H  
- 112 L  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
12  
31  
23  
59  
99  
HOLIDAY #1 – START MONTH  
HOLIDAY #1 – START DAY OF MONTH  
HOLIDAY #1 – START HOUR  
66 H  
66 L  
HOLIDAY #1 – START MINUTE  
HOLIDAY #1 – NUMBER OF DAYS  
67 L  
68 H - 6A  
L
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
HOLIDAY #2 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #3 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #4 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
6B H - 6D  
L
6E H  
- 70 L  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
135  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
113 H  
- 115 L  
116 H  
71 H - 73 L  
74 H - 76L  
77 H - 79 L  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
-
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
0
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
NA  
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
255  
HOLIDAY #5 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #6 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #7 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #8 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #9 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #10 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #11 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #12 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #13 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #14 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #15 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #16 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #17 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #18 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #19 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
HOLIDAY #20 (SAME FORMAT AS HOLIDAY #1)  
- 118 L  
119 H  
- 121 L  
122 H  
- 124 L  
125 H  
- 127 L  
128 H  
- 130 L  
131 H  
- 133 L  
134 H  
- 136 L  
137 H  
- 139 L  
140 H  
- 142 L  
143 H  
- 145 L  
146 H  
- 148 L  
149 H  
- 151 L  
152 H  
- 154 L  
155 H  
- 157 L  
158 H  
- 160 L  
7A H - 7C  
L
7D H  
- 7F L  
80 H - 82 L  
83 H - 85 L  
86 H - 88 L  
89 H - 8B  
L
8C H  
- 8E L  
8F H - 91  
L
92 H - 94 L  
95 H - 97 L  
98 H - 9A  
L
9B H - 9D  
L
9E H - A0L  
A1 H  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT  
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
161 H  
161 L  
162 H  
162 L  
163 H  
163 L  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, LOW BYTE, 16 BIT  
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
A1 L  
-
0
OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT  
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
A2 H  
-
0
OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, LOW BYTE, 16 BIT  
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
A2 L  
-
0
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT  
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
A3 H  
-
0
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE (1/10 DEGREES, LOW BYTE, 16 BIT  
VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
A3 L  
-
0
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
136  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
SPACE SENSOR TEMPERATURE (ROOM AIR) (1/10 DEGREES,  
HIGH BYTE, 16 BIT VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
SPACE SENSOR TEMPERATURE (ROOM AIR) (1/10 DEGREES,  
LOW BYTE, 16 BIT VALUE, 0 = -40 DEGREES F)  
SPACE SENSOR OFFSET RANGE (DEGREES)  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY (%)  
A4 H  
A4 L  
164 H  
164 L  
-
-
0
0
255  
255  
A5 L  
A6 L  
A7 L  
A8 H  
A8 L  
165 L  
166 L  
167 L  
168 H  
168 L  
3
-
0
0
0
0
0
5
100  
100  
255  
255  
-
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY (%)  
-
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) VALUE (PPM VALUE, HIGH BYTE)  
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) VALUE (PPM VALUE, LOW BYTE)  
BUILDING PRESSURE VALUE (0.001” WC, HIGH BYTE, 0 = -0.250”  
WC, MAX = 0.250” WC)  
-
A9 H  
A9 L  
AA H  
AA L  
AB H  
AB L  
169 H  
169 L  
170 H  
170 L  
171 H  
171 L  
-
-
0
0
0
0
0
0
255  
255  
255  
255  
200  
200  
BUILDING PRESSURE VALUE (0.001” WC, LOW BYTE, 0 = -0.250”  
WC, MAX = 0.250” WC)  
DUCT PRESSURE VALUE (0.01” WC, HIGH BYTE, 0 = 0.00” WC,  
MAX = 5.00” WC)  
-
DUCT PRESSURE VALUE (0.01” WC, LOW BYTE, 0 = 0.00” WC, MAX  
= 5.00” WC)  
-
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT VALUE (0.05 VDC COUNTS FOR  
COOLING SAT SETPOINT SCALING)  
0
40  
DEMAND VENTILATION SETPOINT (25 PPM INCREMENTS,  
MAXIMUM 5000 PPM)  
AIR QUALITY (DV) SENSOR RANGE (25 PPM INCREMENTS,  
MAXIMUM 5000 PPM)  
AC L  
AD L  
AE H  
172 L  
173 L  
174 H  
80  
60  
45  
0
0
0
200  
240  
100  
UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME PERIOD (MINUTES)  
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE COOLING LOCKOUT  
TEMPERATURE (DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)  
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE HEATING LOCKOUT  
TEMPERATURE (DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)  
SAT COOLING LIMIT SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
SAT HEATING LIMIT SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT (DEGREES  
F)  
AE L  
174 L  
75  
0
100  
AF H  
AF L  
175 H  
175 L  
50  
40  
65  
135  
100  
180  
6
B0 H  
B0 L  
176 H  
176 L  
120  
150  
80  
80  
180  
180  
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR SETPOINT (DEGREES  
F)  
B1 H  
B1 L  
177 H  
177 L  
80  
70  
60  
60  
85  
85  
COMFORT VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE: UPPER SETPOINT  
(DEGREES F)  
B2 H  
B2 L  
178 H  
178 L  
60  
55  
40  
40  
70  
70  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE: LOWER SETPOINT  
(DEGREES F)  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE: RESET SETPOINT  
(DEGREES F)  
B3 H  
B3 L  
179 H  
179 L  
72  
68  
40  
40  
85  
85  
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
137  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
MORNING WARM-UP AND VAV HEATING: RETURN AIR  
TEMPERATURE SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
B4 H  
B5 H  
B5 L  
B6 H  
180 H  
181 H  
181 L  
182 H  
70  
60  
50  
0
85  
DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT (0.025” WC INCREMENTS, DEFAULT  
= 1.500” WC « 60)  
200  
200  
100  
DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT (0.025” WC  
INCREMENTS, DEFAULT = 4.500” WC « 180)  
BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT (0.005” WC INCREMENTS, 0 =  
-0.250” WC, DEFAULT = 0.100” WC « 70)  
180  
70  
0
0
B7 H  
B7 L  
B8 H  
183 H  
183 L  
184 H  
55  
50  
20  
40  
40  
0
65  
65  
ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE (UPPER) SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE (LOWER) SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION (PERCENT)  
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT (BTU PER  
POUND)  
100  
B9 H  
B9 L  
BA H  
185 H  
185 L  
186 H  
27  
27  
55  
10  
10  
40  
50  
50  
80  
ECONOMIZER RETURN AIR ENTHALPY SETPOINT (BTU PER  
POUND)  
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMPERATURE ENABLE SETPOINT  
(DEGREES F)  
BB H  
BB L  
187 H  
187 L  
4
0
0
0
23  
59  
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (HOURS)  
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (MINUTES)  
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN ON  
– MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)  
BC H  
BC L  
BD H  
BD L  
BE H  
BE L  
BF H  
188 H  
188 L  
189 H  
189 L  
190 H  
190 L  
191 H  
80  
20  
60  
20  
0
10  
0
100  
90  
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN OFF  
– MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN  
ON – NON-MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST FAN TO TURN  
OFF – NON-MODULATING ONLY (PERCENT)  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE ALARM SETPOINT FOR COOLING  
(DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)  
10  
0
100  
90  
0
80  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE ALARM SETPOINT FOR HEATING  
(DEGREES F, 0 = DISABLED)  
0
0
120  
25  
SPACE SENSOR ALARM TEMPERATURE (DEGREES F, 0 =  
DISABLED)  
5
0
BF L  
C2 H  
C3 H  
191 L  
194 H  
195 H  
60  
0
0
0
-
120  
255  
-
SPACE SENSOR ALARM TIME (MINUTES, 0 = DISABLED)  
INTELLI-START RECOVERY TIME (MINUTES, 0 = DISABLED)  
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #1 HIGH BYTE  
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #1 LOW BYTE. (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
-
C3 L  
C4 H  
C4 L  
C5 H  
C5 L  
195 L  
196 H  
196 L  
197 H  
197 L  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #2 HIGH BYTE  
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #2 LOW BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #3 HIGH BYTE  
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #3 LOW BYTE. (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
138  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
-
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
C6 H  
C6 L  
198 H  
198 L  
-
-
-
-
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #4 HIGH BYTE  
ASCD TIMER FOR COMPRESSOR #4 LOW BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
-
COMPRESSOR #1 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
C7 H  
C7 L  
C8 H  
C8 L  
C9 H  
C9 L  
CA H  
CA L  
199 H  
199 L  
200 H  
200 L  
201 H  
201 L  
202 H  
202 L  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
COMPRESSOR #1 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
COMPRESSOR #2 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
COMPRESSOR #2 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
COMPRESSOR #3 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
COMPRESSOR #3 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
COMPRESSOR #4 MINIMUM RUN TIMER HIGH BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
COMPRESSOR #4 MINIMUM RUN TIMER LOW BYTE (SECONDS,  
COUNTS DOWN)  
CB H  
CB L  
CC H  
CD H  
CD L  
CE H  
CE L  
203 H  
203 L  
204 H  
205 H  
205 L  
206 H  
206 L  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
FAN ASCD TIMER HIGH BYTE (ALWAYS ZERO)  
FAN ASCD TIMER LOW BYTE. (SECONDS, COUNTS DOWN)  
FAN MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS DOWN)  
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)  
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)  
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR COOL (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)  
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR COOL (SECONDS, COUNT DOWN)  
ACCUMULATED UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME (HOURS, HIGH  
BYTE)  
-
0
0
0
0
0
CF H  
CF L  
207 H  
207 L  
0
0
0
0
255  
255  
ACCUMULATED UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME (HOURS, LOW  
BYTE)  
6
D4 H  
D4 L  
D5 H  
D5 L  
D6 H  
D7 H  
212 H  
212 L  
213 H  
213 L  
214 H  
215 H  
-
-
0
0
0
0
0
-
100  
100  
100  
100  
100  
-
SUPPLY FAN VFD OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)  
EXHAUST DAMPER OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)  
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)  
HOT GAS REHEAT VALVE OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER OUTPUT STATUS, 0-100% (2 – 10 VDC)  
OPTION BYTE #6  
-
-
-
NA  
0
0
1 = COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOLING ENABLED  
1 = COMFORT VENTILATION FOR HEATING ENABLED  
1 = TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY CONTROL ENABLED  
1 = HOT GAS REHEAT ALTERNATE OPERATION ENABLED  
1 = NETWORK OCCUPIED FLAG: OCC IS ON  
NA  
1
2
3
4
5
6
1 = DIFFERENTIAL ENTHALPY MODE ENABLED  
NA  
7
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
139  
User Interface Control Center  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE - 6-2 - SIMPLICITY ELITE DATA MAP (CONT.)  
INITIAL/  
ADDRESS ADDRESS  
DEFAULT  
VALUE  
(HEX)  
0
MIN  
MAX  
BIT  
DESCRIPTION  
(HEX)  
(DEC)  
VALUE VALUE  
D7L  
215 L  
NA  
0
-
-
OPTION BYTE #7  
1 = ERV ENABLED  
1
1 = ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLED  
NA  
2-7  
D8 H  
D8 L  
D9 H  
216 H  
216 L  
217 H  
S
50  
3
0
20  
0
100  
80  
5
HOT GAS REHEAT HUMIDITY SETPOINT (PERCENT HUMIDITY)  
TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY SETPOINT (PERCENT HUMIDITY)  
MAXIMUM TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY OFFSET (DEGREES F)  
TEMPERATURE / HUMIDITY VALUE THAT = 1° F OF OFFSET  
(PERCENT HUMIDITY)  
D9 L  
217 L  
5
1
10  
DB H  
DB L  
DC H  
DC L  
219 H  
219 L  
220 H  
220 L  
72  
68  
-
45  
45  
10  
10  
99  
99  
50  
50  
OPERATING COOLING SETPOINT (DEGREES F) [CV]  
OPERATING HEATING SETPOINT (DEGREES F) [CV]  
OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY (BTUS PER POUND)  
RETURN AIR ENTHALPY (BTUS PER POUND)  
MAXIMUM DEMAND VENTILATION ECONOMIZER POSITION  
(PERCENT OPEN)  
-
DE L  
DF H  
E0 H  
222 L  
223 H  
224 H  
50  
-
0
0
-
100  
10  
-
SPACE SENSOR OFFSET (0 = -5° F, 10 = +5° F)  
ASCD TIMER FOR HEATING STAGE #1 (SECONDS, COUNTS  
DOWN)  
-
HEATING STAGE #1 MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS  
DOWN)  
E0 L  
E1 H  
E1 L  
E2 H  
E2 L  
224 L  
225 H  
225 L  
226 H  
226 L  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
ASCD TIMER FOR HEATING STAGE #2 (SECONDS, COUNTS  
DOWN)  
HEATING STAGE #2 MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS  
DOWN)  
ASCD TIMER FOR HEATING STAGE #3 (SECONDS, COUNTS  
DOWN)  
HEATING STAGE #3 MINIMUM RUN TIMER (SECONDS, COUNTS  
DOWN)  
E3 H  
E3 L  
227 H  
227 L  
0
0
0
0
99  
60  
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION (PERCENT)  
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT (DEGREES F)  
140  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 7 – PARAMETER DESCRIPTIONS AND OPTIONS  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE ACCUMULATED TIME THE UNIT  
HAS PLACED IN UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE MODE.  
ACCUMULATED UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME  
ACTIVE ALARM  
ADDRESS  
THIS IDENTIFIES THE NUMBER OF ACTIVE ALARMS PRESENT  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO SET THE COMMUNICATION  
ADDRESS FOR THE UNIT WHEN CONNECTED TO A NETWORK  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE STATUS OF THE SUPPLY FAN AIR  
PROVING SWITCH. 0 = SWITCH OPEN, 1 = SWITCH CLOSED  
APS DATA  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE BUILDING PRESSURE  
SETPOINT FOR THE CONTROL OF BUILDING EXHAUST  
OPERATION  
BUILDING PRESSURE SETPOINT  
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE  
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE INPUT  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE THE USE  
OF BUILDING PRESSURE IN THE OPERATION OF THE EXHAUST  
FUNCTION  
BUILDING STATIC PRESSURE SENSOR  
INSTALLED  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLED  
COMFORT VENTILATION DURING COOLING MODE OPERATION  
ON A CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT  
COMFORT VENTILATION FOR COOLING  
ENABLED  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE COMFORT  
VENTILATION DURING HEATING MODE OPERATION ON A  
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT  
COMFORT VENTILATION FOR HEATING  
ENABLED  
THIS PARAMETER IS THE LOWER SETPOINT USED BY THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER TO DETERMINE WHEN TO SWITCH THE UNIT IN  
COMFORT VENTILATION MODE  
COMFORT VENTILATION LOWER SETPOINT  
COMFORT VENTILATION UPPER SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER IS THE UPPER SETPOINT USED BY THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER TO DETERMINE WHEN TO SWITCH THE UNIT IN  
COMFORT VENTILATION MODE  
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE  
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 1 IS IN THIS MODE  
COMP 1 ASCD ACTIVE  
COMP 1 ASCD TIMER  
COMP 1 MIN RUN TIME  
COMP 1 OUTPUT  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR  
COMPRESSOR 1 IN SECONDS.  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR  
COMPRESSOR 1 IN SECONDS.  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 1  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 TO  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
7
COMP 1 OVERLOAD SWITCH  
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE  
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 2 IS IN THIS MODE  
COMP 2 ASCD ACTIVE  
COMP 2 ASCD TIMER  
COMP 2 MIN RUN TIME  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR  
COMPRESSOR 2 IN SECONDS.  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR  
COMPRESSOR 2 IN SECONDS.  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
141  
Parameter Description and Options  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 2  
COMP 2 OUTPUT  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 TO  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
COMP 2 OVERLOAD SWITCH  
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE  
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 3 IS IN THIS MODE  
COMP 3 ASCD ACTIVE  
COMP 3 ASCD TIMER  
COMP 3 MIN RUN TIME  
COMP 3 OUTPUT  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR  
COMPRESSOR 3 IN SECONDS.  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR  
COMPRESSOR 3 IN SECONDS.  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 3  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 3 TO  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
COMP 3 OVERLOAD SWITCH  
THIS IS USED TO DETERMINE THE STATUS OF THE OFF CYCLE  
TIMER. ON MEANS THE COMPRESSOR 4 IS IN THIS MODE  
COMP 4 ASCD ACTIVE  
COMP 4 ASCD TIMER  
COMP 4 MIN RUN TIME  
COMP 4 OUTPUT  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR  
COMPRESSOR 4 IN SECONDS.  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR  
COMPRESSOR 4 IN SECONDS.  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO COMPRESSOR CIRCUIT 4  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
COMPRESSOR OVERLOAD FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 4 TO  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
COMP 4 OVERLOAD SWITCH  
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM  
1 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE  
COMPRESSOR #1 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME  
COMPRESSOR #2 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME  
COMPRESSOR #3 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME  
COMPRESSOR #4 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME  
COMPRESSORS AVAILABLE FOR COOLING  
CONDENSER FAN #1 OUTPUT  
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM  
2 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE  
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM  
3 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE  
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT COMPRESSOR SYSTEM  
4 HAS BEEN OPERATIVE  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE NUMBERS OF COMPRESSOR  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS SET UP TO CONTROL  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE #1 CONDENSER FAN, OFF OR ON  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE #2 CONDENSER FAN, OFF OR ON  
CONDENSER FAN #2 OUTPUT  
WHEN THIS PARAMETER IS TURNED ON, ON A CONSTANT  
VOLUME UNIT THE SUPPLY FAN WILL OPERATE WHENEVER  
THE UNIT IS IN THE OCCUPIED MODE  
CONTINUOUS INDOOR FAN OPERATION WITH  
SENSOR  
THIS IDENTIFIES IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS IN THE COMFORT  
VENTILATION MODE. OFF NOT IN MODE, ON IN COMFORT  
VENTILATION MODE.  
CONTROL IN COMFORT VENTILATION  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
142  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY  
BETWEEN THE TIME THE COOLING CALL IS TERMINATED AND  
THE SHUT DOWN OF THE SUPPLY FAN  
COOL FAN OFF DELAY  
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY  
BETWEEN THE TIME THE COOLING CALL IS INITIATED AND THE  
START OF THE SUPPLY FAN  
COOL FAN ON DELAY  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ALLOW COOLING  
OPERATION  
COOLING MODE OPERATION ENABLE  
COOL 1 (Y1)  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y1  
- FIRST STAGE COOLING  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y2  
- SECOND STAGE COOLING  
COOL 2 (Y2)  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y3  
- THIRD STAGE COOLING  
COOL 3 (Y3)  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL Y4  
- FOURTH STAGE COOLING  
COOL 4 (Y4)  
THIS IDENTIFIES THE ADDRESS OF THE UNIT ON THE  
NETWORK  
CURRENT BUS ADDRESS  
CV CURRENT OPERATING COOLING SETPOINT  
CV CURRENT OPERATING HEATING SETPOINT  
CV OCCUPIED COOLING SET POINT  
CV OCCUPIED HEATING SET POINT  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE COOLING SET POINT THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER IS CONTROLLING TO COOLING TOO  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE HEATING SET POINT THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER IS CONTROLLING TO HEATING TOO  
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT  
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE OCCUPIED COOLING MODE.  
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT  
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE OCCUPIED HEATING MODE.  
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT  
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE UNOCCUPIED COOLING  
MODE.  
CV UNOCCUPIED COOLING SET POINT  
THIS IS THE SPACE OR RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE THE UNIT  
WILL CONTROL TO WHEN IN THE UNOCCUPIED HEATING MODE.  
CV UNOCCUPIED HEATING SET POINT  
DAY OF MONTH  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE CURRENT DAY OF  
THE MONTH, 1 - 31  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE DAY OF THE WEEK  
(1-7) WITH 1 EQUAL TO SUNDAY  
DAY OF WEEK  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE DEMAND  
VENTILATION. DEMAND VENTILATION INCREASE THE AMOUNT  
OF VENTILATION AIR IN RESPONSE TO A INCREASE IN THE CO2  
LEVEL IN THE CONDITIONED SPACE  
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) ENABLED  
7
DEMAND VENTILATION (IAQ) VALUE (CO2)  
DIFFERENTIAL ENTHALPY MODE ENABLED  
THIS THE CO2 INPUT VALUE TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER IN PPM  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IN ORDER TO USE  
DIFFERENTIAL ENTHALPY  
THIS PARAMETER GIVE THE STATUS OF THE DIRTY FILTER  
SWITCH, 0 = CLEAN, 1 = DIRTY  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH DATA  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
143  
Parameter Description and Options  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE SET TO ON TO ENABLE THE DIRTY  
FILTER FEATURE ON THE UNIT. A DIRTY FILTER SWITCH MUST  
ALSO BE INSTALLED FOR THIS FEATURE TO FUNCTION  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INSTALLED  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER VARIES THE SPEED OF THE SUPPLY  
FAN ON A VAV UNIT TO MAINTAIN THIS PROGRAMMED  
SETPOINT  
DUCT PRESSURE SETPOINT  
IF THE DUCT STATIC PRESSURE ON A VAV UNIT EXCEED THIS  
VALUE THE UNIT WILL SHUT DOWN THE FAN AND LOCK OUT  
THE UNIT  
DUCT PRESSURE SHUTDOWN SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE DUCT  
STATIC PRESSURE INPUT  
DUCT STATIC READING  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE UNIT CONTROLLER OUTPUT  
TO THE ECONOMIZER DAMPER IN %  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER OUTPUT STATUS  
WHEN ON/OFF EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS IS THE POSITION  
OF THE ECONOMIZER DAMPER TO TURN OFF THE EXHAUST  
FAN  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR  
EXHAUST TURN OFF  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER POSITION FOR  
EXHAUST TURN ON  
WHEN ON/OFF EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS IS THE POSITION  
OF THE ECONOMIZER DAMPER TO TURN ON THE EXHAUST FAN  
ON A CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT THE UNIT CONTROLLER WILL  
TRY AND MAINTAIN THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE AT THIS  
SETPOINT IN THE ECONOMIZER MODE WITH A FIRST STAGE  
COOLING CALL  
ECONOMIZER FIRST STAGE SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURN ON TO ENABLE ECONOMIZER  
OPERATION  
ECONOMIZER INSTALLED  
ECONOMIZER IS CURRENTLY USING FREE  
COOLING  
THIS IDENTIFIES IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS USING OUTDOOR  
AIR TO SATISFY THE COOLING DEMAND, OFF OR ON  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE  
ECONOMIZER LOADING  
ECONOMIZER LOADING ENABLE  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE POSITION OF THE  
OUTDOOR DAMPER WHEN THE ECONOMIZER IS INACTIVE AND  
THE UNIT IS IN THE OCCUPIED MODE  
ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION  
THIS IS THE OUTDOOR ENTHALPY SETTING WHICH  
DETERMINES WHEN TO SWITCH INTO AND OUT OF  
ECONOMIZER OPERATION IN SINGLE ENTHALPY ECONOMIZER  
MODE  
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY  
SETPOINT  
ECONOMIZER OUTSIDE AIR TEMP ENABLE  
SETPOINT  
THIS IS THE OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE WHICH DETERMINES  
WHEN TO SWITCH INTO AND OUT OF ECONOMIZER OPERATION  
ON A CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT THE UNIT CONTROLLER WILL  
TRY AND MAINTAIN THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE AT THIS  
SETPOINT IN THE ECONOMIZER MODE WITH A SECOND STAGE  
COOLING CALL  
ECONOMIZER SECOND STAGE SETPOINT  
ERV INSTALLED  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IF AN ENERGY  
RECOVERY VENTILATOR IS INSTALLED. THIS FEATURE IS  
CURRENTLY NOT AVAILABLE ON THESE UNITS  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
144  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS PARAMETER ALLOWS THE EXHAUST FAN TO OPERATE  
ANYTIME THE SUPPLY FAN IS ON. THIS FEATURE IS REQUIRED  
WHEN AN ENERGY RECOVERY VENTILATOR IS INSTALLED.  
THIS FEATURE IS CURRENTLY NOT USED ON THESE UNITS.  
ERV UNOCCUPIED FAN ENABLE  
WHEN MODULATING DAMPER EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS IS  
THE POSITION OF THE EXHAUST DAMPER TO TURN OFF THE  
EXHAUST FAN  
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST  
TO TURN OFF  
WHEN MODULATING DAMPER EXHAUST IS BEING USED THIS  
IS THE POSITION OF THE EXHAUST DAMPER TO TURN ON THE  
EXHAUST FAN  
EXHAUST DAMPER POSITION FOR EXHAUST  
TO TURN ON  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE EXHAUST FAN, OFF OR ON  
EXHAUST FAN OUTPUT  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG UNIT CONTROLLER  
EXHAUST DAMPER / VFD OUTPUT STATUS  
OUTPUT TO THE EXHAUST DAMPER OR EXHAUST FAN VFD IN  
%
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER THAT  
AN EXHAUST FAN VFD IS INSTALLED. THE PARAMETER MUST  
BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE  
EXHAUST VFD INSTALLED  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO THE G  
TERMINAL OF THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF OR ON  
FAN (G) THERMOSTAT INPUT  
FAN ASD TIMER  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE SUPPLY FAN OFF DELAY IN  
SECONDS  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME OFF DELAY IN  
SECONDS  
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR COOL  
FAN OFF DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT  
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR COOL  
FAN ON DELAY TIMER FOR HEAT  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME OFF DELAY IN  
SECONDS  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME ON DELAY IN  
SECONDS  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COOLING TIME ON DELAY IN  
SECONDS  
THIS IS THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE  
STAT TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER. OFF = FAULTED, ON =  
NORMAL OPERATION  
FREEZE THERMOSTAT SWITCH  
GAS VALVE #1  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE GAS  
VALVE FOR HEAT SECTION 1 TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER OFF /  
ON  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE GAS  
GAS VALVE #2  
VALVE FOR HEAT SECTION 2 TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER OFF /  
ON  
7
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE GAS  
VALVE FOR HEAT SECTION 3 TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER OFF /  
ON  
GAS VALVE #3  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL W1  
- FIRST STAGE HEATING  
HEAT 1 (W1)  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR  
HEAT SECTION 1 IN SECONDS.  
HEAT 1 ASCD TIMER  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
145  
Parameter Description and Options  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME  
TIMER FOR HEAT SECTION 1 IN SECONDS  
HEAT 1 MIN RUN TIMER  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL W2  
- SECOND STAGE HEATING  
HEAT 2 (W2)  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR  
HEAT SECTION 2 IN SECONDS.  
HEAT 2 ASCD TIMER  
HEAT 2 MIN RUN TIMER  
HEAT 3 (W3)  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME  
TIMER FOR HEAT SECTION 2 IN SECONDS  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL W3  
- THIRD STAGE HEATING  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE OFF CYCLE TIMER FOR  
HEAT SECTION 3 IN SECONDS.  
HEAT 3 ASCD TIMER  
HEAT 3 MIN RUN TIMER  
THIS GIVES THE ACTUAL TIME OF THE MINIMUM RUN TIME  
TIMER FOR HEAT SECTION 3 IN SECONDS  
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY  
BETWEEN THE TIME THE HEAT CALL IS TERMINATED AND THE  
SHUT DOWN OF THE SUPPLY FAN  
HEAT FAN OFF DELAY  
HEAT FAN ON DELAY  
IN THE INTERMITTENT FAN MODE THIS IS THE TIME DELAY  
BETWEEN THE TIME THE HEATING OPERATION IS VERIFIED  
AND THE START OF SUPPLY FAN OPERATION  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ALLOW HEATING  
OPERATION  
HEATING MODE ENABLED FOR OPERATION  
HEATING NUMBER #1 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME  
HEATING NUMBER #2 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME  
HEATING NUMBER #3 ACCUMULATED RUNTIME  
HEATING OUTPUT #1 (H1)  
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT HEATING SYSTEM 1 HAS  
BEEN OPERATIVE  
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT HEATING SYSTEM 2 HAS  
BEEN OPERATIVE  
THIS IS THE NUMBER OF HOURS THAT HEATING SYSTEM 3 HAS  
BEEN OPERATIVE  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER TO HEAT SECTION # 1, OFF/ON  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER TO HEAT SECTION # 2, OFF/ON  
HEATING OUTPUT #2 (H2)  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER TO HEAT SECTION # 3, OFF/ON  
HEATING OUTPUT #3 (H3)  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON WHEN HOT GAS  
BYPASS IS INSTALLED  
HOT GAS PRESENT ON COMPRESSOR # 1  
HOT GAS REHEAT  
THIS PARAMETER WOULD BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE HOT GAS  
REHEAT. THIS FEATURE IS NOT AVAILABLE ON THESE UNITS  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG UNIT CONTROLLER  
OUTPUT TO THE HYDRONIC VALVE IN %  
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT STATUS  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG UNIT CONTROLLER  
OUTPUT TO THE HYDRONIC VALVE IN % WHEN THE UNIT IS  
PROGRAMMED FOR A REVERSE ACTING VALVE  
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT STATUS  
(REVERSE ACTING)  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE HOUR OF THE  
CURRENT TIME BASED ON A 24 HOUR SCHEDULE, 13 WOULD  
BE 1 PM  
HOUR  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
146  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
HSP1  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
HSP2  
HSP3  
HSP4  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 3 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE HIGH  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 4 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
THIS PARAMETER REVERSES THE ACTION OF THE HYDRONIC  
VALVE. WHEN THE PARAMETER IS TURNED ON A 2 VOLT INPUT  
TO THE VALVE IS FULL OPEN AND A 10 VOLT INPUT TO THE  
VALVE IS FULL CLOSED  
HYDRONIC HEAT ACTUATOR VALVE REVERSE  
ACTING  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE HYDRONIC  
HEATING OPERATION  
HYDRONIC HEATING ENABLED  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE SETPOINT FOR  
CONSTANT VOLUME HYDRONIC HEATING OPERATION DURING  
FIRST STAGE OPERATION  
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #1 SUPPLY AIR  
SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE SETPOINT FOR  
CONSTANT VOLUME HYDRONIC HEATING OPERATION DURING  
SECOND STAGE OPERATION AND ALSO THE CONTROL  
SETPOINT FOR VAV HYDRONIC HEATING OPERATION  
HYDRONIC HEATING STAGE #2 SUPPLY AIR  
SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER THE  
RANGE OF THE CO2 SENSOR IN PPM  
IAQ SENSOR RANGE  
IAQ SETPOINT  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER WILL TRY AND MAINTAIN THE CO2  
LEVEL IN THE SPACE TO WITHIN +/- 100 PPM OF THIS VALUE  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL G  
- SUPPLY FAN  
INDOOR FAN (G)  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE MINIMUM SUPPLY FAN RUN  
TIME IN SECONDS  
INDOOR FAN MIN RUN TIME  
INDOOR FAN OUTPUT  
INDOOR FAN VFD OUTPUT  
INPUT AIR PROVING SWITCH  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE SUPPLY FAN  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE ANALOG OUTPUT FROM THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER TO THE SUPPLY FAN IN %  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE AIR PROVING SWITCH INPUT TO  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF OR ON  
7
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INPUT TO  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF - CLEAN FILTER, ON - DIRTY  
FILTER  
INPUT DIRTY FILTER SWITCH  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
SUPPLY FAN OVERLOAD TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER, OFF -  
FAULT, ON - NORMAL OPERATION  
INPUT INDOOR FAN OVERLOAD SWITCH  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
147  
Parameter Description and Options  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS FEATURE IS ONLY AVAILABLE ON CONSTANT VOLUME  
UNITS WITH A SPACE SENSOR USING THE INTERNAL  
SCHEDULE. THIS OPTION BRINGS THE UNIT UP TO THE CV  
OCCUPIED COOLING OR CV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINTS  
PRIOR TO THE BEGINNING OF OCCUPIED OPERATION.  
INTELLI-START OPERATION ENABLE  
LAST ALARM 1  
LAST ALARM 2  
LAST ALARM 3  
LAST ALARM 4  
LAST ALARM 5  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE MOST RECENT ALARM  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM PRECEDING ALARM 1  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM PRECEDING ALARM 2  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM PRECEDING ALARM 3  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE ALARM OLDEST IN HISTORY  
LEAD-LAG EQUALIZE COMPRESSOR RUN TIME THIS PARAMETER ENABLES LEAD LAG OPERATION FOR THE  
ENABLED  
COMPRESSOR, OFF OR ON  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
LIMIT SWITCH TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER FOR HEAT SECTION 1  
IN SECONDS. OFF - FAULTED, ON - NORMAL  
LIMIT SWITCH #1  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
LIMIT SWITCH TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER FOR HEAT SECTION 2  
IN SECONDS. OFF - FAULTED, ON - NORMAL  
LIMIT SWITCH #2  
LIMIT SWITCH #3  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE  
LIMIT SWITCH TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER FOR HEAT SECTION 3  
IN SECONDS. OFF - FAULTED, ON - NORMAL  
THIS FEATURE CAN BE USED TO TEMPORALLY REDUCE THE  
ELECTRICAL CONSUMPTION OF THE UNIT BY TURNING OFF  
ALL OF THE ACTIVE COMPRESSORS. THIS FEATURE IS ONLY  
AVAILABLE THROUGH A COMMUNICATED INPUT.  
LOADSHED  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES IF THE SUPPLY VOLTAGE TO THE  
CONTROL IS OUTSIDE THE ACCEPTABLE LIMITS. OFF = WITHIN  
LIMITS, ON = FAULTED, OUTSIDE LIMITS  
LOW AC SUPPLY VOLTAGE DETECTED  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE MINIMUM POSITION  
FOR THE OUTDOOR AIR DAMPER DURING LOW AMBIENT  
OPERATION  
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER MINIMUM  
POSITION  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO TURN ON AND SET THE  
OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE AT WHICH THIS FEATURE BECOMES  
ACTIVE. A 0 VALUE TURNS THE FEATURE OFF. THIS FEATURE  
REDUCES THE MINIMUM VENTILATION POSITION OF THE  
OUTDOOR DAMPER DURING TIMES OF COLD OUTDOOR  
TEMPERATURES  
LOW AMBIENT ECONOMIZER SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IF A LOW AMBIENT  
VFD IS INSTALLED ON THE CONDENSER FAN. THIS ALLOWS  
COMPRESSOR OPERATION BELOW 45.0° F  
LOW AMBIENT KIT INSTALLED  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
LPS1  
LPS2  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
148  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 3 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
LPS3  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT FROM THE LOW  
PRESSURE SWITCH FOR COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 4 TO THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER. ON - OKAY, OFF - FAULTED.  
LPS4  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHED THE MAXIMUM POSITION  
THE OUTDOOR DAMPER CAN OPEN TO IN THE DEMAND  
VENTILATION MODE  
MAXIMUM IAQ ECONOMIZER POSITION  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE STATUS OF THE UNOCCUPIED  
METER OF UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE ENABLED OVERRIDE INPUT. OFF MEANS IT IS NOT IN OVERRIDE MODE  
AND ON MEANS IT IS IN OVERRIDE MODE.  
WHEN THIS OPTION IS TURNED ON THE TEMPERATURE DATA  
METRIC OPERATION  
WILL BE CONVERTED TO METRIC UNITS. 0 = IMPERIAL, 1 =  
METRIC  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR  
THE COMPRESSORS, 1 TO 10 MINUTES  
MINIMUM RUN TIME FOR COMPRESSORS  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE MINUTES OF THE  
CURRENT TIME.  
MINUTE  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IN ORDER TO USE  
MODULATING EXHAUST, EITHER DAMPER OR VFD  
MODULATING POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED  
MONTH  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE CURRENT MONTH 1  
TO 12. FOR EXAMPLE 1 WOULD BE JANUARY  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO DETERMINE THE ON AND OFF  
POINTS FOR VAV OCCUPIED HEATING OPERATION IN THE  
STAND ALONE OR SPACE SENSOR MODE OF OPERATION. IT  
IS ALSO USED TO CONTROL THE HEATING OPTION IN THE  
MORNING WARM-UP MODE.  
MORNING WARM-UP / VAV RETURN AIR TEMP  
SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE MORNING  
WARM-UP OPERATION  
MORNING WARM-UP ENABLE  
NETWORK OCCUPIED FLAG  
OCC INPUT  
THIS GIVES THE STATUS OF THE COMMUNICATED OCCUPIED  
COMMAND, OFF UNOCCUPIED, ON OCCUPIED  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL OCC  
- OCCUPIED INPUT  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON IN ORDER TO USE THE  
HARD WIRED OR COMMUNICATED OCCUPIED INPUT. IT MUST  
BE TURNED OFF IN ORDER TO USE THE DAILY OR HOLIDAY  
SCHEDULING FEATURE  
OCCUPIED INPUT ENABLED  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES AN OUTDOOR SET POINT TO  
LOCKOUT COOLING OPERATION. WHEN THE TEMPERATURE IS  
BELOW THIS SETTING COOLING IS LOCKED OUT  
7
OUTDOOR AIR TEMP COOLING LOCKOUT  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES AN OUTDOOR SET POINT TO  
LOCKOUT HEATING OPERATION. WHEN THE TEMPERATURE IS  
ABOVE THIS SETTING HEATING IS LOCKED OUT  
OUTDOOR AIR TEMP HEATING LOCKOUT  
OUTSIDE AIR ENTHALPY  
THIS PARAMETER IS THE CALCULATED VALUE FOR THE  
OUTDOOR AIR ENTHALPY  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
149  
Parameter Description and Options  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE  
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY INPUT  
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY  
THIS PARAMETERS IDENTIFIES TO THE UNIT CONTROLLER  
THAT AN OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR IS INSTALLED  
OUTSIDE AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED  
OUTSIDE AIR TEMP  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE FOR THE  
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE POWER  
EXHAUST OPERATION  
POWER EXHAUST INSTALLED  
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE ENABLE  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO TURN ON THE PRE-OCCUPANCY  
PURGE OPTION. THIS FEATURE TURNS ON THE SUPPLY FAN  
AND OPENS THE OUTDOOR AIR DAMPER PRIOR TO GOING  
INTO THE OCCUPIED MODE.  
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (HOURS OF  
DAY)  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE NUMBER OF HOURS  
PRIOR TO THE OCCUPIED START TIME THAT THE PRE-  
OCCUPANCY PURGE WOULD START  
PRE-OCCUPANCY PURGE TIME (MINUTES OF  
DAY)  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE NUMBER OF MINUTES  
PRIOR TO THE OCCUPIED START TIME THAT THE PRE-  
OCCUPANCY PURGE WOULD START  
PURGE SWITCH  
REDLINE  
THIS IS THE STATUS OF THE BINARY INPUT TO TERMINAL  
PURGE - PURGE MODE  
THIS FEATURE CAN BE USED TO TEMPORALLY REDUCE THE  
ELECTRICAL CONSUMPTION OF THE UNIT BY TURNING OFF  
SOME OF THE ACTIVE COMPRESSORS. THIS FEATURE IS ONLY  
AVAILABLE THROUGH A COMMUNICATED INPUT.  
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT ENABLE FOR THIRD THIS ALLOWS THE USE OF AN EXTERNAL 0 TO 10 VDC SIGNAL  
PARTY BAS  
TO RESET THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE SETPOINT ON VAV  
UNITS.  
REMOTE CONTROL INPUT VALUE  
RETURN AIR ENTHALPY  
GIVES THE VALUE OF THE 0 TO 10 VDC REMOTE CONTROL  
INPUT FOR THE REMOTE CONTROL OF THE DAMPERS  
THIS PARAMETER IS THE CALCULATED VALUE FOR THE  
RETURN AIR ENTHALPY  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY INPUT  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR INSTALLED  
THIS IS THE RETURN ENTHALPY SETTING WHICH THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER USES TO DETERMINE WHEN TO SWITCH INTO  
ECONOMIZER OPERATION IN DUAL ENTHALPY ECONOMIZER  
MODE  
RETURN AIR TEMP  
RUN TEST  
THIS PARAMETER GIVE THE CURRENT VALUE FOR THE  
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT  
BY TURNING THIS FEATURE ON THE UNIT CONTROLLER  
SEQUENCING ON ALL THE BINARY OUTPUTS TO VERIFY  
OPERATION OF THE UNIT ELECTRICAL DEVICES  
SENSOR SPACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR  
OUTSET  
THIS IS THE ACTUAL SPACE SENSOR OFFSET AMOUNT BEING  
USED BY THE UNIT CONTROLLER IN DEGREES.  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
150  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
SPACE SENSOR DETECTED  
IDENTIFIES IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER HAS DETECTED THE  
PRESENCE OF A SPACE SENSOR. IF THE UNIT CONTROLLER  
DETECTS A SPACE SENSOR IT WILL SELF CONFIGURE TO USE  
IT FOR CONTROL OF THE UNIT.  
SPACE SENSOR FAULT OVERRIDE ENABLE  
WHEN THIS OPTION IS TURNED ON THE CONTROLLER USES  
THE RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT IN PLACE OF THE  
SPACE TEMPERATURE INPUT TO CONTROL THE UNIT. TURING  
THIS OPTION ON ALLOWS THE UNIT TO OPERATE IN A VAV  
STAND ALONE MODE  
SPACE TEMP  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE OF THE SPACE  
TEMPERATURE INPUT  
SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP  
TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE THE PARAMETER MUST BE SET  
TO OTHER THEN 0. A VALUE OTHER THEN 0 IS THE NUMBER  
OF DEGREES ABOVE OR BELOW THE SETPOINT THE  
TEMPERATURE MUST BE TO START THE TIMING  
SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHED THE AMOUNT OF TIME THE  
SPACE TEMPERATURE MUST BE TRENDING ABOVE OR BELOW  
THE SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP BEFORE THE ALARM  
WILL BE INITIATED.  
SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET RANGE  
STAGES OF HEAT AVAILABLE  
THIS SETPOINT ESTABLISHES THE MAXIMUM AMOUNT OF  
HEATING OR COOLING RESET AVAILABLE THROUGH THE  
RESET FEATURE ON A SPACE SENSOR.  
THIS PARAMETER IDENTIFIES THE NUMBER OF STAGES OF  
HEAT THE UNIT CONTROLLER IS SET UP TO CONTROL  
STATE COMPRESSOR OFF - LOW SUPPLY  
VOLTAGE  
THIS IDENTIFIES THE COMPRESSORS ARE OFF BECAUSE OF  
LOW SUPPLY VOLTAGE. ON WHEN THIS STATE IS ACTIVE  
STATE COMPRESSORS OFF - LOW AMBIENT  
TEMPERATURE  
THIS IDENTIFIES THE COMPRESSOR ARE OFF BECAUSE  
THE OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE IS BELOW THE LOW AMBIENT  
LOCKOUT TEMPERATURE. ON WHEN THIS STATE IS ACTIVE  
STATUS COMPRESSOR OFF - ECON IS USING  
FREE COOLING  
THIS IDENTIFIES THE COMPRESSORS ARE OFF BECAUSE THE  
UNIT CONTROLLER IS USING OUTDOOR AIR FOR COOLING. ON  
WHEN THIS IS ACTIVE  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE CURRENT VALUE FOR THE  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR  
COOLING  
TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE THE PARAMETER MUST BE SET TO  
OTHER THEN 0. A VALUE OTHER THEN 0 ESTABLISHES THE  
SETPOINT TO USE IN DETERMINE WHEN TO INITIATE A SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP ALARM FOR COOLING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM SETPOINT FOR  
HEATING  
TO ENABLE THIS FEATURE THE PARAMETER MUST BE SET TO  
OTHER THEN 0. A VALUE OTHER THEN 0 ESTABLISHES THE  
SETPOINT TO USE IN DETERMINE WHEN TO INITIATE A SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP ALARM FOR HEATING  
7
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT COOLING SETPOINT  
THIS SET POINT IS USED BY THE UNIT CONTROLLER DURING  
ECONOMIZER LOADING OR SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT MODE OF  
OPERATION  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
151  
Parameter Description and Options  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 7-1 – DEFINITIONS (CONTINUED)  
MENU ITEM  
DEFINITION  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR COOLING  
ENABLE  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LIMIT OPERATION IN THE COOLING MODE ON A  
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING  
ENABLED  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ENABLE SUPPLY  
AIR TEMP LIMIT OPERATION IN THE HEATING MODE ON A  
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT HEATING SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED BY THE UNIT CONTROLLER DURING  
SUPPLY AIR TEMP LIMIT FOR HEATING OPERATION ON A  
CONSTANT VOLUME UNIT.  
TEMPERATURE/HUMIDITY (RETURN) CONTROL THIS PARAMETER WOULD BE USED IF HOT GAS REHEAT WAS  
ENABLED  
BEING USED. THIS FEATURE IS NOT AVAILABLE ON THESE  
UNITS. THIS SHOULD ALWAYS BE SET TO OFF  
THIRD PARTY BAS ECONOMIZER ENABLED  
WHEN THIS PARAMETER IS TURNED ON THE POSITION OF THE  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER IS CONTROLLED BY AN EXTERNAL 2-10  
VDC INPUT  
TURN OFF CONTINUOUS FAN WHEN STARTING IF THIS PARAMETER IS TURNED ON AND THE UNIT IS RUNNING  
HEAT  
CONTINUOUS FAN, THE CONTROL WILL STOP THE SUPPLY FAN  
AT THE START OF A HEATING CYCLE AND TURN IT BACK ON  
BASED ON THE FAN ON FOR HEAT SETTING  
UNIT MODEL NUMBER  
UNIT NAME  
THIS ALLOWS THE UNIT MODEL NUMBER TO BE ENTERED FOR  
THE UNIT THROUGH THE SIMPLICITY PC SOFTWARE  
THIS ALLOWS A NAME TO BE ASSIGNED TO THE UNIT TO  
IDENTIFY IT ON THE NETWORK THROUGH THE SIMPLICITY PC  
SOFTWARE  
UNIT SERIAL NUMBER  
THIS ALLOWS THE UNIT SERIAL NUMBER TO BE ENTERED FOR  
THE UNIT THROUGH THE SIMPLICITY PC SOFTWARE  
UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE TIME PERIOD  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE MAXIMUM TIME THE UNIT  
WILL REMAIN IN THE UNOCCUPIED OVERRIDE MODE WHEN  
THE OVERRIDE BUTTON IS PUSHED ON THE SPACE SENSOR.  
VAV / CV SELECTION  
THIS PARAMETER GIVES THE STATUS OF THE SET UP OF THE  
UNIT , VAV OR CV  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP LOWER  
SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE LOWER COOLING  
SETPOINT FOR VAV COOLING OPERATION  
VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR TEMP UPPER  
SETPOINT  
THIS PARAMETER ESTABLISHES THE UPPER COOLING  
SETPOINT FOR VAV COOLING OPERATION  
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING ENABLED  
THIS PARAMETER MUST BE TURNED ON TO ALLOW OCCUPIED  
HEATING OPERATION.  
VAV OCCUPIED HEATING SETPOINT  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER COMPARES THE SPACE TEMPERATURE  
TO THIS VALUE AS ONE OF THE CRITERIA TO USE TO  
DETERMINE WHEN TO INITIATE VAV OCCUPIED HEATING  
OPERATION  
VAV SUPPLY AIR TEMP RESET SETPOINT  
THE UNIT CONTROLLER COMPARES THE SPACE OR RETURN  
AIR TEMPERATURE TO THIS VALVE TO DETERMINE IF IT  
SHOULD CONTROL TO THE VAV COOLING SUPPLY AIR UPPER  
OR LOWER SETPOINT  
YEAR  
THIS PARAMETER IS USED TO ENTER THE CURRENT YEAR 0 TO  
99. FOR EXAMPLE 7 WOULD BE 2007  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
152  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
SECTION 8 – SERVICE  
ANALOG INPUT OPERATION  
Duct Pressure Transducer  
This section describes the control operation of the (29)  
twenty-nine analog inputs. These inputs are used by  
the control to monitor and respond to unit temperatures,  
pressures, enthalpy, etc. The location of each of these  
connections on the Unit Controller is contained in  
Table 8-8. Notice that the ID gives the jack connection  
designated as “J” and then the identifying number of  
the connector, followed by a – and then the pin number  
of the connector. For example the SUPPLY AIR  
TEMPERATURE analog input would be found at J1-1.  
This is connector J1 – Pin 1. As the Unit Control board  
is positioned in the control box the top row of the J series  
connectors is the input, the middle row is the common,  
and the bottom row is the 5 VDC input to the sensor.  
Also the pin in the right hand top corner is pin 1.  
The Duct Pressure Transducer is located behind the right  
hand damper door. The purpose of the transducer is to  
sense and convert the static pressure in the supply-side  
of the duct to a 0 to 5 volt DC voltage. The DC voltage  
is sent to the Unit Controller and compared against the  
“DUCT STATIC PRESS ACTIVE SP”. The transducer is  
factory wired, but pneumatic tubing must be field supplied  
and installed (refer to Section 2 “INSTALLATION” in this  
manual). The Duct Static Pressure Transducer measures  
differential pressure between the pressure in the duct  
and atmospheric pressure. When verifying transducer  
operation, the technician must insert a tee in the pneumatic  
tubing and connect a manometer to the tee to verify the  
pressure being applied to the transducer. Once this pressure  
is known, a comparison can be made of the duct pressure  
vs. output volts DC from the transducer. Table 8-2 shows  
the relationship between the pressure applied to the duct  
pressure transducer and the output voltage. The output is  
linear between 0" WC and the SPAN. The “DUCT PRESS  
TRANSDUCER SPAN” can be set to 1.25, 2.5 or 5" WC.  
The “DUCT PRESS TRANSDUCER SPAN” must always  
be set based on the span of the transducer installed.  
Temperature Sensors  
The temperature sensors are all 10KType IIIThermistors.  
The relationship between the temperature and the  
voltage output and resistance is contained in Table 8-1  
.The following analog input are of this type: Supply  
Air Temperature, Heat Entering Temp, Flex Evap Temp,  
Outside Air Temp, Return Air Temp, Suction Temp #1,  
Suction Temp #2, Zone Temp, and Under Floor Temp.  
TABLE 8-1 – TEMPERATURE SENSOR RESISTANCE  
°F  
-25  
-20  
-15  
-10  
-5  
VOLTAGE  
RESISTANCE  
°C  
°F  
VOLTAGE  
RESISTANCE  
16,744  
14,681  
13,216  
11,771  
10,502  
9,388  
°C  
55  
60  
2.36  
2.51  
2.66  
2.80  
2.94  
3.08  
3.21  
3.33  
3.45  
3.56  
3.66  
3.76  
3.85  
3.94  
4.02  
4.09  
4.16  
12.78  
15.56  
18.33  
21.11  
23.89  
26.67  
29.45  
32.22  
35.0  
0.49  
0.53  
0.60  
0.69  
0.78  
139,639  
127,453  
109,624  
94,519  
-30.6  
-28.9  
65  
-26.1  
70  
-23.34  
-20.55  
75  
81,665  
80  
85  
8,404  
0.0  
5
0.88  
0.98  
1.10  
1.22  
1.35  
1.48  
1.62  
1.77  
1.91  
2.06  
2.21  
70,750  
61,418  
53,426  
46,582  
40,703  
35,639  
31,269  
27,490  
24,219  
21,377  
18,900  
-17.78  
-15.00  
-12.22  
-9.44  
-6.67  
-3.89  
-1.11  
1.67  
90  
7,537  
95  
6,770  
10  
15  
20  
25  
30  
35  
40  
45  
50  
100  
105  
110  
115  
120  
125  
130  
135  
6,090  
37.78  
40.56  
43.34  
46.11  
48.89  
51.66  
54.44  
57.22  
5,487  
4,951  
4,475  
4,050  
3,671  
4.44  
3,332  
7.22  
3,029  
8
10.00  
153  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Service  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 8-2 – DUCT PRESSURE TRANSDUCER  
Return Fan Pressure Transducer  
1.25" WC SPAN  
2.5" WC SPAN  
5.0" WC SPAN  
VOLTAGE  
VDC  
DIFFERENTIAL DIFFERENTIAL  
DIFFERENTIAL  
INPUT PRESS  
0.5  
If the unit is order with the Return Fan Option the  
unit will have a Return Fan Pressure Transducer. The  
transducer is behind the right hand damper door and  
compares the pressure in the return air compartment to  
atmospheric pressure. The Unit Controller varies the  
speed of the Return Fan in order to maintain the correct  
differential pressure in the return compartment. When  
verifying transducer operation, the technician can inset a  
tee into the pneumatic tubing and connect a manometer  
to the tee to verify the pressure being applied to the  
transducer. Once this pressure is known, a comparison  
can be made of the return compartment pressure vs.  
output volts DC from the transducer. A practical and  
quick check of this transducer can also be accomplished  
by removing the pneumatic tubing lines from both the  
low and high side connections on the transducer. Since  
both of the inputs will now be exposed to the same  
pressure, the differential pressure will be zero, and the  
output 2.5 volts DC according to Table 8-4.  
INPUT PRESS  
0.125  
0.25  
INPUT PRESS  
0.25  
0.50  
1.00  
1.50  
2.00  
2.50  
3.00  
3.50  
4.00  
4.50  
5.00  
0.50  
1.0  
0.375  
0.50  
0.75  
1.50  
1.00  
2.00  
0.625  
0.75  
1.25  
2.50  
1.50  
3.00  
0.875  
1.00  
1.75  
3.50  
2.00  
4.00  
1.125  
1.25  
2.25  
4.50  
2.50  
5.00  
Building Pressure Transducer  
The Building Pressure Transducer is located behind the  
right hand damper door. The purpose of the transducer is  
to sense and convert the static pressure in the building to  
a 0 to 5 volt DC voltage. The DC voltage is then sent to  
the Unit Controller and compared against the “BUILDING  
PRESSURE ACTIVE SETPOINT”. The transducer is  
factory wired, but pneumatic tubing must be field supplied  
and installed (refer to Section 2 “INSTALLATION” in this  
manual). The Building Pressure Transducer measures  
differential pressure in the building and atmospheric  
pressure. When verifying transducer operation, the  
technician can inset a tee into the pneumatic tubing and  
connect a manometer to the tee to verify the pressure being  
applied to the transducer. Once this pressure is known, a  
comparison can be made of the building pressure vs. output  
volts DC from the transducer. Apractical and quick check  
of this transducer can also be accomplished by removing  
the pneumatic tubing lines from both the low and high side  
connections on the transducer. Since both of the inputs  
will now be exposed to the same pressure, the differential  
pressure will be zero, and the output 2.5 volts DC according  
to Table 8-3.  
TABLE 8-4 – RETURN FAN PRESSURE  
TRANSDUCER OUTPUT  
DIFFERENTIAL INPUT  
PRESSURE - IWC  
OUPTUT VOLTAGE - VDC  
-1.00  
-0.80  
-0.60  
-0.40  
-0.20  
0.00  
0.20  
0.40  
0.60  
0.80  
1.00  
0.00  
0.50  
1.00  
1.50  
2.00  
2.50  
3.00  
3.50  
4.00  
4.50  
5.00  
TABLE 8-3 – BUILDING PRESSURE TRANSDUCER OUTPUT  
DIFFERENTIAL INPUT  
PRESSURE - IWC  
-0.50  
OUPTUT VOLTAGE - VDC  
Discharge Pressure Transducer  
0.00  
0.50  
1.00  
1.50  
2.00  
2.50  
3.00  
3.50  
4.00  
4.50  
5.00  
The discharge Pressure Transducer is located in the  
common discharge line of the tandem compressors for  
each refrigerant circuit. The purpose of this transducer  
is to sense and convert the discharge pressure into a  
DC voltage. The DC voltage is then sent to the Unit  
Controller where it is used to control the number of  
condenser fan when the unit is in cooling operation.  
The discharge pressure value, in PSIG, is displayed by  
the User Interface.  
-0.40  
-0.30  
-0.20  
-0.10  
0.00  
0.10  
0.20  
0.30  
0.40  
0.50  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
154  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Humidity Sensors  
The Discharge Transducer has a range of 0 to 650  
PSIG, with a linear output of 0 to 5 DC volts. Table  
8-5 illustrates the DC volt output from the transducer  
for a given discharge pressure.  
The humidity sensor outputs a 0 to 5 volts DC in response  
to the relative humidity sensed. An outdoor air humidity  
sensor is used whenever the economizer is configured  
for single or dual enthalpy. Areturn air humidity sensor  
is used whenever the economizer is configured for dual  
enthalpy. A humidity sensor is also used to monitor  
the humidity in the space between the slab and raised  
floor system used for FlexSys applications. Table 8-6  
gives the relationship between the voltage output of the  
humidity sensor and the % relative humidity.  
Suction Pressure Transducer  
The optional suction pressure transducer is located in  
the common suction line of the tandem compressors for  
each refrigerant circuit. The purpose of the transducer  
is to sense and convert the suction pressure to a DC  
voltage. The DC voltage is then sent to the Unit  
Controller where it is displayed by the User Interface.  
When this option is installed the Unit Controller will  
also calculate and display the Evaporator Superheat  
value for the system.  
TABLE 8-6 – HUMIDITY SENSOR OUTPUTS  
% RELATIVE  
HUMIDITY  
5
% RELATIVE  
HUMIDITY  
55  
0.25  
0.50  
0.75  
1.00  
1.25  
1.50  
1.75  
2.00  
2.25  
2.50  
2.75  
3.00  
3.25  
3.50  
3.75  
4.00  
4.25  
4.50  
4.75  
5.00  
The Suction Transducer has a range of 0 to 400 PSIG,  
with a linear output of 0 to 5 volts DC. Table 8-5  
illustrates the DC volt output from the transducer for a  
given suction pressure.  
10  
15  
20  
25  
30  
35  
40  
45  
50  
60  
65  
70  
75  
80  
85  
90  
95  
100  
TABLE 8-5 – PRESSURE TRANSDUCERS  
SUCTION TRANSDUCER  
DISCHARGE TRANSDUCER  
PRESSURE  
VOLTAGE  
VDC  
PRESSURE  
VOLTAGE  
VDC  
PSIG  
PSIG  
0
0.5  
0
0.5  
25  
0.75  
1
32.5  
65  
0.7  
0.9  
1.1  
1.3  
1.5  
1.7  
1.9  
2.1  
2.3  
2.5  
2.7  
2.9  
3.1  
3.3  
3.5  
3.7  
3.9  
4.1  
4.3  
4.5  
50  
75  
1.25  
1.5  
1.75  
2
97.5  
130  
100  
125  
150  
175  
200  
225  
250  
275  
300  
325  
350  
375  
400  
162.5  
195  
2.25  
2.5  
2.75  
3
227.5  
260  
292.5  
325  
3.25  
3.5  
3.75  
4
357.5  
390  
422.5  
455  
4.25  
4.5  
487.5  
520  
552.5  
585  
617.5  
650  
8
155  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Service  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
CO2 Sensor  
Furnace Status Input  
Two CO2 sensors are used in conjunction with the  
“DEMAND VENTILATION” option. In “DEMAND  
VENTILATION” the Unit Control monitors the CO2 level  
of the outdoor air and the CO2 level in the conditioned  
space and varies the amount of ventilation air based on  
the relationship between these two values. Table 8-7  
gives the volts DC output for a given CO2 level.  
The Unit Controller monitors the operation of the  
Staged and Modulating Gas Heat sections and displays  
the status through the STATUS screen of the User  
Interface. The operation of each of the gas heat sections  
is monitored by a multiplexer installed in the gas heat  
section. When a gas heat section is energized, it sends a  
24-volt signal to the multiplexer. The multiplexer takes  
the five “ON”/”OFF” inputs and converts them into a  
0 to 5 volt DC signal that is sent to the Unit Controller.  
The Unit Controller then decodes this analog input and  
displays the furnace section status. Tables 8-9 and 8-10  
show the relationship between the DC voltage and the  
furnace operation status.  
TABLE 8-7 – CO2 SENSOR OUTPUT  
PPM CO2  
OUTPUT  
VOLTAGE  
VDC  
PPM CO2  
OUTPUT  
VOLTAGE  
VDC  
80  
160  
240  
320  
400  
480  
560  
640  
720  
800  
880  
960  
1040  
0.20  
0.40  
0.60  
0.80  
1.00  
1.20  
1.40  
1.60  
1.80  
2.00  
2.20  
2.40  
2.60  
1120  
1200  
1280  
1360  
1440  
1520  
1600  
1680  
1760  
1840  
1920  
2000  
2.80  
3.00  
3.20  
3.40  
3.60  
3.80  
4.00  
4.20  
4.40  
4.60  
4.80  
5.00  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
156  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TERMINALS  
FSI  
P21  
P7  
P20  
SD2  
P19  
P8  
P11  
P9  
P22  
P6  
COM  
FSP  
SD1  
R
P15  
P1  
P2  
P16  
P5  
P4  
TERM. VAV OPEN +  
TERM. VAV OPEN -  
P3  
LD13124  
P14  
P10  
P13  
P12  
TERM  
24VAC  
FIG. 8-1 – CONNECTOR LOCATIONS  
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA  
CONNECTOR #  
TYPE  
IDENTIFICATION  
WIRE #  
DESCRIPTION  
P9  
P9  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AI  
AO  
AO  
AO  
BP-  
BP+  
340  
339  
-
BUILDING PRESSURE INPUT -  
BUILDING PRESSURE INPUT +  
CV VAV CONFIGURATION RESISTOR  
DUCT STATIC PRESSURE INPUT -  
DUCT STATIC PRESSURE INPUT +  
DEMAND VENTILATION INPUT -  
DEAMND VENTILATION INPUT +  
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT  
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT  
OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY INPUT -  
OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY INPUT +  
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE -  
P7  
CV/VAV  
DP-  
P21  
P21  
P20  
P20  
P11  
P11  
P6  
338  
337  
-
DP+  
DV-  
DV+  
-
OAT-  
OAT+  
OH-  
330  
329  
334  
333  
332  
331  
336  
335  
309  
308  
406  
405  
408  
P6  
OH+  
RAT-  
RAT+  
RH-  
P11  
P11  
P6  
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE +  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY INPUT 1  
RETURN AIR HUMIDITY INPUT +  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE INPUT  
OUTDOOR DAMPER OUTPUT -  
OUTDOOR DAMPER OUTPUT +  
EXHAUST FAN VFD / DAMPER OUTPUT-  
P6  
RH+  
P11  
P11  
P14  
P14  
P14  
SAT-  
SAT+  
ECO-  
ECO+  
EXD-  
8
Continued on next page  
157  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Service  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA (CONTINUED)  
CONNECTOR #  
TYPE  
IDENTIFICATION  
WIRE #  
DESCRIPTION  
P14  
P14  
P14  
P14  
P14  
P14  
P14  
P4  
AO  
AO  
AO  
AO  
AO  
AO  
AO  
COMM  
COMM  
COMM  
DI  
EXD+  
HGR-  
HGR+  
HWV-  
HWV+  
VFD-  
VFD+  
RS-485 B  
RS-485 A  
RS-485  
C10  
407  
EXHAUST FAN VFD / DAMPER OUTPUT+  
NOT USED  
-
-
NOT USED  
410  
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT -  
HOT WATER VALVE OUTPUT +  
SUPPLY FAN VFD OUTPUT -  
409  
402  
401  
SUPPLY FAN VFD OUTPUT +  
-
(+) COMMUNICATION CONNECTION  
(-) COMMUNICATION CONNECTION  
CONNECTION FOR SIMPLICITY PC SOFTWARE  
COMPRESSOR 1A MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT  
P4  
-
P5  
-
P12  
P12  
P12  
P12  
P12  
P12  
P12  
P10  
P10  
P10  
JUMPER  
DI  
C20  
JUMP / 440 COMPRESSOR 1B MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT  
JUMP / 441 24 VAC TO COMMON  
DI  
C20  
DI  
C30  
JUMP / 442 COMPRESSOR 2A MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT  
JUMP / 443 24 VAC TO COMMON  
DI  
C30  
DI  
C40  
JUMP / 444 COMPRESSOR 2B MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT  
JUMP / 445 24 VAC TO COMMON  
DI  
C40  
DI  
GV1  
510  
525  
536  
HEAT SECTION 1 GAS VALVE INPUT  
HEAT SECTION 2 GAS VALVE INPUT  
HEAT SECTION 3 GAS VALVE INPUT  
24 VAC INPUT TO UNIT CONTROLLER FOR BINARY  
OUTPUTS  
DI  
GV2  
DI  
GV3  
TERMINAL  
DI  
24 VAC  
301  
P11  
P11  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
APS  
APS  
411  
412  
AIR PROVING SIWTCH INPUT  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
P12  
C10  
JUMPER  
304  
COMPRESSOR 1A MOTOR PROTECTION CIRCUIT  
24 VAC COMMON  
TERMINAL  
P22  
COM  
FILT  
390  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH INPUT  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
P22  
FILT  
391  
P16  
FOVR  
FOVR  
FSI  
JUMP / 404 24 VAC TO COMMON  
P16  
JUMP / 403 SUPPLY FAN OVERLOAD INPUT CV UNITS ONLY  
TERMINAL  
TERMINAL  
P15  
388  
389  
399  
400  
-
FREEZE STAT INPUT  
FSP  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
HSP1  
HSP1  
HSP2  
HSP2  
HSP3  
HSP3  
HSP4  
HSP4  
LIM1  
LIM2  
LIM3  
LPS1  
LPS1  
LPS2  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
P15  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 HIGH PRESSURE INPUT  
NOT USED  
P15  
P15  
400  
431  
432  
-
JUMPERED TO HSP1  
P16  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
P16  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 1 HIGH PRESSURE INPUT  
NOT USED  
P16  
P16  
432  
507  
522  
533  
395  
396  
-
JUMPERED TO HSP3  
P10  
HEAT SECTION 1 LIMIT INPUT  
HEAT SECTION 2 LIMIT INPUT  
HEAT SECTION 3 LIMIT INPUT  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
P10  
P10  
P15  
P15  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 LOW PRESSURE INPUT  
NOT USED  
P15  
Continued on next page  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
158  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 8-8 – WIRING DATA (CONTINUED)  
CONNECTOR #  
TYPE  
IDENTIFICATION  
WIRE #  
DESCRIPTION  
P15  
P16  
P16  
P16  
P16  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
DI  
LPS2  
LPS3  
LSP3  
LPS4  
LPS4  
396  
JUMPERED TO LSP1  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
433  
434  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 LOW PRESSURE INPUT  
NOT USED  
-
434  
JUMPERED TO LSP3  
SD  
TERMINAL  
TERMINAL  
DI  
DI  
R
24 VAC INPUT TO UNIT CONTROLLER  
INPUT FOR SMOKE SHUTDOWN  
JUMPER  
SD  
SDI  
JUMPER  
TERMINAL  
P12  
P12  
P12  
P12  
P13  
P13  
P13  
P13  
P10  
P10  
P10  
P3  
DI  
DO  
SD2  
303  
24 VAC TO COMMON  
C1  
427  
COMPRESSOR 1A OUTPUT  
COMPRESSOR 1BOUTPUT  
COMPRESSOR 2A OUTPUT  
COMPRESSOR 2B OUTPUT  
CONDENSER FAN BANK 1 OUTPUT  
CONDENSER FAN BANK 2 OUTPUT  
EXHAUST FAN OUTPUT  
DO  
C2  
428  
DO  
C3  
429  
DO  
C4  
430  
DO  
CF1  
423  
DO  
CF2  
425  
DO  
EXH  
422  
DO  
FAN  
421  
SUPPLY FAN OUTPUT  
DO  
H1  
570  
HEAT SECTION ONE OUTPUT  
HEAT SECTION TWO OUTPUT  
HEAT SECTION 3 OUTPUT  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER INPUT - VDC  
ECONOMIZER DAMPER INPUT + VDC  
COMMON SIDE OF 24 VAC SUPPLY  
SUPPLY FAN INPUT  
DO  
H2  
572  
DO  
H3  
574  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD INPUT  
FIELD OUTPUT / AO  
FIELD OUTPUT / AO  
BAS ECON -  
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
P3  
BAS ECON +  
P1  
C
P1  
G
OCC  
PURGE  
R
P1  
OCCUPIED INPUT  
P3  
SMOKE PURGE INPUT  
P1  
HOT SIDE OF 24 VAC SUPPLY  
REMOTE RESET -  
P19  
P19  
P1  
REM-  
REM+  
SD  
REMOTE RESET +  
NOT USED  
P8  
GND  
SSO  
ST  
SPACE TEMPERATURE INPUT COMMON  
SPACE TEMP SENSOR OFFSET +  
SPACE TEMPERATURE INPUT +  
IST STAGE HEAT INPUT  
P8  
P8  
P2  
W1  
P2  
W2  
2ND STAGE HEAT INPUT  
P2  
W3  
3RD STAGE HEAT INPUT  
P1  
X
FAULT OUTPUT  
P2  
Y1  
1ST STAGECOOLING INPUT  
2ND STATE COOLING INPUT  
3RD STAGE COOLING INPUT  
4TH STAGE COOLING INPUT  
IDENTIFIES UNIT IS IN THE HEATING MODE (24 VDC -)  
IDENTIFIES UNIT IS IN THE HEATING MODE (24VDC +)  
P2  
Y2  
P2  
Y3  
P3  
Y4  
TERMINAL  
TERMINAL  
VAV OPEN -  
VAV OPEN +  
8
159  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Service  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
FAULTS AND LOCKOUTS  
LIGHT EMITTING DIODE  
ALARM CODES  
The light emitting diode (LED) installed on the Unit  
Controller is used to indicate the functionality of the  
Unit Controller and the unit. Normal operation is  
indicated by the LED flashing ON and OFF at a rate  
of one-second. A one-second ON followed by a one-  
second OFF flash. This means there are no active flash  
codes, faults or clock-outs. However there may be faults  
recorded in the history buffer.  
An active alarm is represented by a flashing alarm code  
numeral. There are 43 alarms in all. Not all the alarms  
are critical enough to shut down the system. Some  
alarms flag the problem to bring it to the attention of  
the operator or technician while allowing the system to  
continue to operate.  
The display flashes the current or most recent code  
and contains the last five failures as well. To recall the  
last five failures from the most recent to the oldest of  
the five, press the “Alarm/Change” button once and  
each code is displayed for two seconds. Each failure  
code is numbered 1 to 5 and the number is shown in  
the two-digit character display located above the four-  
digit display.  
A flash rate of 250 ms ON and OFF indicates a current  
alarm is present. The alarm code number will also be  
flashing on the four-digit character display. See Table  
8-9 for a description of each of the alarm codes.  
If the LED is constantly on (does not flash), the board  
has failed and must be replaced. If the LED is OFF  
this indicates no power to the board or a board failure.  
Two flashes ON, then two-seconds OFF indicates the  
control is timing out on an Anti-Cycle-Delay (ASCD).  
To bypass theASCD timer depress the TEST/UPbutton  
3 times within 5 seconds.  
The current and last five alarms can also be views under  
the “ALARM” tab using the Simplicity PC software.  
A unit lockout can be reset in three ways:  
Removing the 24 VAC supply to the Unit Con-  
troller.  
Press the TEST/UP button twice in 5 seconds.  
By a communicated command.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
160  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 8-9 – ALARM CODE DESCRIPTIONS  
ALARM CODE  
DESCRIPTION  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.  
01  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
07  
08  
09  
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON HIGH PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 2-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1 (COMPRESSORS 1A, 1B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2 (COMPRESSORS 2A, 2B) LOCKED OUT ON LOW PRESSURE CONTROL. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1A LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 1B LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2A LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
COMPRESSOR SYSTEM 2B LOCKED OUT ON COMPRESSOR MOTOR PROTECTION MODULE. THE CIRCUIT  
OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
FIRST STAGE HEATING IS LOCKED OUT ON LIMIT SWITCH TRIPS. THE CIRCUIT OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN  
A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
SECOND STAGE HEATING IS LOCKED OUT ON LIMIT SWITCH TRIPS. THE CIRCUIT OPENED THREE TIMES  
WITHIN A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
THIRD STAGE HEATING IS LOCKED OUT ON LIMIT SWITCH TRIPS. THE CIRCUIT OPENED THREE TIMES WITHIN  
A 1-HOUR WINDOW.  
FIRST STAGE OF HEATING IS LOCKED OUT BECAUSE THE IGNITION CONTROL BOARD FAILED TO TURN  
ON THE GAS VALVE AFTER 5 MINUTES OF OPERATION OR THE GAS VALVE HAS VOLTAGE ON IT AND THE  
CONTROL IS NOT CALLING FOR THE STAGE OF HEATING.  
16  
17  
18  
SECOND STAGE OF HEATING IS LOCKED OUT BECAUSE THE IGNITION CONTROL BOARD FAILED TO TURN  
ON THE GAS VALVE AFTER 5 MINUTES OF OPERATION OR THE GAS VALVE HAS VOLTAGE ON IT AND THE  
CONTROL IS NOT CALLING FOR THE STAGE OF HEATING.  
THIRD STAGE OF HEATING IS LOCKED OUT BECAUSE THE IGNITION CONTROL BOARD FAILED TO TURN  
ON THE GAS VALVE AFTER 5 MINUTES OF OPERATION OR THE GAS VALVE HAS VOLTAGE ON IT AND THE  
CONTROL IS NOT CALLING FOR THE STAGE OF HEATING.  
19  
20  
21  
22  
SPACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.  
SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.  
RETURN AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.  
OUTDOOR AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR HAS FAILED OPEN OR SHORTED. THE DISPLAY WILL INDICATE –40.0.  
DIRTY FILTER SWITCH HAS CLOSED INDICATING THE FILTERS NEED REPLACED. THIS HAS NO EFFECT ON  
THE OPERATION OF THE UNIT.  
23  
8
Continued on next page  
161  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Service  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
TABLE 8-9 – ALARM CODE DESCRIPTIONS (CONTINUED)  
ALARM CODE  
DESCRIPTION  
THE SUPPLY FAN BINARY OUTPUT HAS BEEN TURNED ON FOR 90 SECONDS AND THE AIR PROVING SWITCH  
CIRCUIT HAS NOT CLOSED.  
24  
THE SUPPLY FAN BINARY OUTPUT HAS BEEN TURNED OFF FOR 90 SECONDS AND THE AIR PROVING SWITCH  
CIRCUIT HAS NOT OPENED.  
25  
26  
27  
A MICROELECTRONICS FAILURE HAS OCCURRED AND THE CONTROL IS OPERATING ON DEFAULTS.  
A MICROELECTRONICS FAILURE HAS OCCURRED AND THE CONTROL IS DOWN DUE TO A FATAL FAULT.  
THIS INDICATES THE SUPPLY FAN BINARY OUTPUT IS TURNED ON AND THE SUPPLY FAN OVERLOAD CIRCUIT  
IS OPEN. THIS HAS TO OCCUR 3 TIMES WITHIN A TWO HOUR WINDOW.  
THIS INDICATES THE OUTDOOR AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR IS OUT OF RANGE. WHEN THIS OCCURS, THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER SWITCHES THE ECONOMIZER TYPE TO DRY BULB.  
28  
29  
30  
31  
THIS INDICATES THE RETURN AIR HUMIDITY SENSOR IS OUT OF RANGE. WHEN THIS OCCURS, THE UNIT  
CONTROLLER SWITCHES THE ECONOMIZER TYPE TO SINGLE ENTHALPY.  
THIS INDICATES THE IAQ (CO2) SENSOR IS OUT OF RANGE. THE UNIT CONTROLLER CHANGES THE  
VENTILATION MODE TO FIXED MINIMUM.  
32  
33  
34  
THIS INDICATES THE REAL TIME CLOCK CANNOT BE READ AS A RESULT OF A HARDWARE FAILURE.  
THIS INDICATES THE SPACE TEMPERATURE OFFSET IS GREATER THAN 20 K OHMS.  
THIS INDICATES THE CV/VAV INPUT IS OUT OF RANGE. THE UNIT WILL LOCK OUT.  
THIS INDICATES THE 24-VOLT SUPPLY CIRCUIT HAS DROPPED BELOW THE ALLOWABLE LEVEL. THE CONTROL  
WILL SHUT DOWN UNTIL THE VOLTAGE RISES ABOVE 19.2 VAC.  
35  
36  
37  
38  
THIS INDICATES THE UNIT COOLING AND HEATING OPERATION IS SHUT DOWN BECAUSE THE UNIT IS  
OPERATING IN A SMOKE PURGE MODE.  
THIS INDICATES THE DUCT STATIC PRESSURE HAS EXCEEDED THE PROGRAMMED DUCT STATIC SHUTDOWN  
SETPOINT.  
THIS INDICATES THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE HAS EXCEEDED THE PROGRAMMED SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
ALARM SETPOINT FOR COOLING.  
THIS INDICATES THE SUPPLY AIR TEMPERATURE HAS EXCEEDED THE PROGRAMMED SUPPLY AIR TEMP  
ALARM SETPOINT FOR HEATING.  
39  
40  
41  
THIS INDICATES AN ECONOMIZER MINIMUM POSITION ALARM.  
THIS INDICATES THE SPACE TEMPERATURE IS ABOVE THE SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP AND MOVING  
AWAY FROM THE SPACE TEMPERATURE SETPOINT.  
THIS INDICATES THE DUCT STATIC HAS NOT RISEN QUICKLY ENOUGH IN A VAV UNIT WHEN THE SUPPLY FAN IS  
ENERGIZED.  
42  
43  
THIS INDICATES THE HYDRONIC HEAT FREEZE STAT HAS OPENED AND THE OUTDOOR TEMPERATURE IS  
BELOW 45.0° F.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
162  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
ALARM TROUBLE SHOOTING  
Since tandem compressors are used there is a single high  
pressure switch for system 1 and one for system 2. If  
the high pressure switch opens both of the compressors  
for that system will be turned off. If the high pressure  
switch for system 1, (compressors 1A, 1B), opens it will  
generate both a 01 and 02 alarm code. Likewise if the  
high pressure switch opens for system 2, (compressors  
2A, 2B), opens it will generate both a 03 and 04 alarm  
code.  
Refrigerant System Alarm Codes  
(01, 02, 03, 04, 09, 10, 11, 12)  
The first 12 alarms involve controls intended to  
protect the compressors. Each compressor system is  
equipped with external circuitry monitoring hardware  
intended to protect the compressor in case the operating  
characteristics of the refrigerant system fall outside the  
safe operating envelope for the compressor. The type of  
protection varies depending on the type of compressor  
used.  
The high pressure switch opens at 625 PSIG and closes  
at 500 PSIG. In order to generate a high pressure  
lockout the high pressure switch must open three times  
within a 2 hour window.  
YPAL 050 Compressors 1A, 1B, 2A, and 2B  
YPAL 051 Compressors 1A, 1B, 2A, and 2B  
YPAL 060 Compressors 1A and 2A  
YPAL 061 Compressor 1A  
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 1 high pressure  
switch circuit from wire 399 at terminal HPS1 of the P15  
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller  
from the high pressure switch is wire 400 at terminal  
HPS1 of the P15 connector. The above input is then  
jumpered to terminal HSP2 of the P15 connector.  
The Compressor Safety Circuit consists of a high-  
pressure cutout switch. Each of the compressors is also  
protected by internal line break switch imbedded in the  
windings of the compressor that protects the compressor  
from excessive current or temperatures. The Unit  
Controller will not be able to identify the internal line  
break switch is open and no fault will be generated or  
reported by the Unit Controller.  
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 2 high pressure  
switch circuit from wire 431 at terminal HPS3 of the P16  
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller  
from the high pressure switch is wire 432 at terminal  
HPS3 of the P16 connector. The above input is then  
jumpered to terminal HPS4 of the P16 connector.  
If the internal line break is open it will appear as  
a compressor failure. To trouble shoot verify the  
compressor contactor for the compressor that is not  
running, is closed and line voltage is present on the  
load and line side of all three legs. If so remove power  
from the unit and remove the cover from the compressor  
control box. Check for an open winding. If all three  
winding are open carefully check the compressor shell.  
If the shell is hot no determination can be made until the  
shell has cooled. If the shell is cool and a winding is  
open the compressor is defective. If the windings close  
as the compressor cools the internal line break switch  
was open. Some possible causes for an open switch are,  
high discharge super heat (low charge), start of a bearing  
failure (partial locked rotor), or high voltage.  
Because there is no external compressor protection  
module on these models jumpers are placed between  
terminals C10 and C10 of the P12 connector for  
compressor 1A, C20 and C20 of the P12 connector for  
compressor 1B, C30 and C30 of the P12 connector for  
compressor 2A, and C40 and C40 of the P12 connector  
for compressor 2B.  
YPAL 060 Compressors 1B and 2B  
YPAL 061 Compressors 1B, 2A and 2B  
The high pressure switches are connected as described  
above; however, the compressors identified above  
employ a compressor protection module. 24 VAC  
power is supplied to the compressor protection module  
for compressor 1B from wire 441 at terminal C20 of  
the P12 connector. The binary input back to the Unit  
Controller from the compressor protection module is  
wire 440 at terminal C20 of the P12 connector.  
The above units also have a low- pressure cutout that  
will be discussed later.  
8
163  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Service  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Limit Switch Alarms (13, 14, 15)  
24 VAC power is supplied to the compressor protection  
module for compressor 2A from wire 443 at terminal  
C30 of the P12 connector. The binary input back to the  
Unit Controller from the compressor protection module  
is wire 442 at terminal C30 of the P12 connector.  
The control monitors the limit switch status for each of  
the heating sections installed. If the limit switch circuit  
opens the control de-energizes the heat section output  
for the section with the open limit circuit and energizes  
the indoor blower output. The supply fan performs a  
Fan Delay Off when the limit re-closes.  
24 VAC power is supplied to the compressor protection  
module for compressor 2B from wire 445 at terminal  
C40 of the P12 connector. The binary input back to the  
Unit Controller from the compressor protection module  
is wire 444 at terminal C40 of the P12 connector.  
In order to generate a limit lockout the limit switch must  
open three times within a 2-hour window.  
Low Pressure Cutout Alarm (09, 10, 11, 12)  
The limit input for heat section 1 is located at terminal  
LIM1 wire 507 of the P10 connector. The limit input  
for heat section 2 is located at terminal LIM2 wire 522  
of the P10 connector. The limit input for heat section  
3 is located at terminal LIM3 wire 533 of the P10  
connector.  
Since tandem compressors are used there is a single low  
pressure switch for system 1 and one for system 2. If  
the low pressure switch opens both of the compressors  
for that system will be turned off. If the low pressure  
switch for system 1, (compressors 1A, 1B), opens it will  
generate both a 09 and 10 alarm code. Likewise if the  
low pressure switch opens for system 2, (compressors  
2A, 2B), opens it will generate both an 11 and 12 alarm  
code.  
Gas Heating Alarms (16, 17, 18)  
The Unit Controller monitors the output to the gas valve.  
If the Unit Controller is calling for the operation of the  
heat stage and voltage is not present after 5 continuous  
minutes it will generate an alarm.  
The low pressure switch opens at 50 PSIG and closes  
at 71 PSIG. In order to generate a low pressure lockout  
the high pressure switch must open three times within  
a 2 hour window.  
If the Unit Controller is not calling for the operation of  
the heat stage and voltage is present at the gas valve for  
5 continuous minutes it will generate an alarm and lock  
on the supply fan. If the input goes away the control  
will revert to normal operation.  
During the start up of the compressor system the low  
pressure switch input is ignored for 30 seconds. After  
the 30 second delay if the low pressure switch circuit  
opens for 5 seconds the Unit Controller will turn off  
both compressors for the system.  
The gas valve input for heat section 1 is located at  
terminal GV1 wire 510 of the P10 connector. The gas  
valve input for heat section 2 is located at terminal GV2  
wire 525 of the P10 connector. The gas valve input for  
heat section 3 is located at terminal GV3 wire 536 of  
the P10 connector.  
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 1 low pressure  
switch circuit from wire 395 at terminal LPS1 of the P15  
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller  
from the low pressure switch is wire 396 at terminal  
LPS1 of the P15 connector. The above input is then  
jumpered to terminal LPS2 of the P15 connector.  
Space Temperature Sensor Alarm (19)  
This alarm indicates the space temperature input is  
either open or shorted. The display will show a value  
of –40.0° F. The space temperature input is at ST and  
GND of the P6 connector. To trouble shoot compare the  
resistance of the input to the temperature in the space  
using Table 8-1.  
24 VAC power is supplied to the system 2 low pressure  
switch circuit from wire 433 at terminal LPS3 of the P16  
connector. The binary input back to the Unit Controller  
from the low pressure switch is wire 434 at terminal  
LPS3 of the P16 connector. The above input is then  
jumpered to terminal LPS4 of the P16 connector.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
164  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Supply Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (20)  
The 24 VAC output to the switch is at terminalAPS wire  
412 of the P11 connector and the input to the control is  
at terminal APS wire 411 of the P11 connector.  
This alarm indicates the supply air temperature input is  
either open or shorted. The display will show a value  
of –40.0° F. The supply air temperature input is at  
SAT+ and SAT- of the P11 connector. To trouble shoot  
compare the resistance of the input to the actual supply  
air temperature using Table 8-1.  
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch Closed Alarm (25)  
This alarm indicates the call for supply fan operation  
has been terminated and after 90 seconds of supply fan  
operation the switch remained closed. The control will  
flash the alarm but allow the unit to operate normally.  
Return Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (21)  
The 24 VAC output to the switch is at terminalAPS wire  
412 of the P11 connector and the input to the control is  
at terminal APS wire 411 of the P11 connector.  
This alarm indicates the return air temperature input is  
either open or shorted. The display will show a value  
of –40.0° F. The return air temperature input is at  
RAT+ and RAT- of the P11 connector. To trouble shoot  
compare the resistance of the input to the actual return  
air temperature using Table 8-1.  
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (26)  
This alarm indicates a problem with the Unit Controller  
microelectronics has occurred and the Unit Controller  
is operating on default values. Try recycling power  
to the control. If the fault reappears replace the Unit  
Controller.  
Outdoor Air Temperature Sensor Alarm (22)  
This alarm indicates the outdoor air temperature input  
is either open or shorted. The display will show a  
value of –40.0° F. The outdoor air temperature input  
is at OAT+ and OAT- of the P11 connector. To trouble  
shoot compare the resistance of the input to the actual  
outdoor air temperature using Table 8-1.  
Microelectronics Failure Alarm (27)  
This alarm indicates a problem with the Unit Controller  
microelectronics has occurred and the Unit Controller is  
shut down. Try recycling power to the control. If the  
fault reappears replace the Unit Controller.  
Dirty Filter Switch Alarm (23)  
This alarm will have no effect on the operation of the  
unit. The alarm indicates the dirty filter switch contacts  
have closed indicating the pressure drop across the filters  
is above the setting of the switch. The 24 VAC output  
to the switch is at terminal FILT wire 391 of the P22  
connector and the input to the control is at terminal FILT  
wire 390 of the P22 connector.  
Supply Fan Overload Alarm (28)  
The Unit Controller monitors this circuit anytime  
the supply fan is operative. If this input is lost for  
50 milliseconds, the control will shut down all unit  
operation. If the voltage input does not return in 5-  
minutes the control will turn on the alarm.  
Supply Fan Air Proving Switch (24)  
If the voltage returns the Unit Controller will log the  
first incident and track the run time. If the switch opens  
three times in a two-hour period the Unit Controller will  
shut down the unit.  
This alarm indicates there was a call for supply fan  
operation and after 90 seconds of supply fan operation  
the switch did not close. The Unit Controller will retry  
the fan output every 30 minutes for three retires. If after  
the three retries the Unit Controller will lockout heating  
and cooling operation.  
The 24 VAC output to the switch is at terminal FOVR  
wire 404 of the P16 connector and the input to the control  
is at terminal FOVR wire 403 of the P16 connector.  
On a VAV unit the Unit Controller will also use the duct  
static pressure input to qualify supply fan operation.  
If the Unit Controller reads more then 0.05" WC it  
will continue to identify the alarm but allow the unit  
to operate.  
8
165  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Service  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Outdoor Humidity Sensor Alarm (29)  
CV/VAV Input Alarm (34)  
This alarm indicates the outdoor humidity sensor is  
out of range. When this occurs the Unit Controller  
will switch economizer operation to Dry Bulb. The  
Outdoor Humidity analog input is at OH+ wire 333 of  
the P6 connector and OH- wire 334 of the P6 connector.  
To trouble shoot the sensor verify 24 VAC between  
terminals EXC and COM of the sensor. Also verify  
the VDC between the OUT and COM connection of the  
sensor. If no voltage is present replace the sensor.  
This alarm indicates the resistance between terminals  
CV/VAV and CV/VAV at the P7 connection is out of  
range. The acceptable range is 0.0 to 20,000 ohms.  
Check the resistance between the two CV/VAV terminals  
and take appropriate action.  
Low Voltage Alarm (35)  
The Unit Controller monitors the 24 VAC input to the  
control. The input has two thresholds. The voltage  
must be above 19.2 VAC or the control will not turn on  
a contactor. If the voltage is not above this value it will  
not turn on the contactor and flashes the fault code. If  
contactors are energized and the voltage drops below  
16 .0 volts the Unit Controller will de-energize the  
contactors and flash the alarm. To trouble shoot check  
the voltage between the “R” and “COM” at the ¼ inch  
terminals on the board.  
Return Humidity Sensor Alarm (30)  
This alarm indicates the return humidity sensor is out  
of range. When this occurs the Unit Controller will  
switch economizer operation to Single Enthalpy. The  
Return Humidity analog input is at RH+ wire 335 of  
the P6 connector and OH- wire 336 of the P6 connector.  
To trouble shoot the sensor verify 24 VAC between  
terminals EXC and COM of the sensor. Also verify  
the VDC between the OUT and COM connection of the  
sensor. If no voltage is present replace the sensor.  
Smoke Purge Mode Alarm (36)  
This is not an alarm but rather an indication the unit  
has been placed in a smoke purge mode. Verify the  
presence of 24 VAC between PURGE connection at  
the P3 connector and “C” on the P1 connector. If 24  
VAC is present and the unit is not supposed to be in the  
Purge mode trace the field wiring to determine why the  
voltage is present.  
IAQ (CO2) Sensor Alarm (31)  
This alarm indicates the IAQ (CO2) sensor is out of  
range. When this occurs the Unit Controller will switch  
the ventilation mode from Demand to Fixed Minimum.  
The IAQ sensor input is at terminal DV+ and DV-. This  
device is field supplied.  
High Duct Static Pressure Alarm (37)  
Time Clock Error Alarm (32)  
This alarm indicates the duct static pressure has exceeded  
the Duct Static Shutdown Setpoint. The problem could  
be caused by a faulty Duct Static Pressure Transducer  
input. To check measure the VDC input between  
terminal DP+ wire 337 at the P21 connector and  
terminal DP- wire 338 at the P21 connector. Compare  
the voltage verses the duct pressure the control indicates  
to Table 8-2 in this section of the manual. Also verify  
that 24 VAC is present between terminals “COM” and  
“EXC” at the duct static transducer.  
This alarm indicates the Unit Controller Real Time  
Clock is not functioning. The Unit Controller will shut  
down all operation. Try recycling power to the control.  
If the fault reappears replace the Unit Controller.  
Space Temperature Offset Alarm (33)  
This alarm is generated when the resistance in the Space  
Temperature Offset circuit is greater then 20,000 ohms.  
The Space Temperature Offset input is at terminals SSD  
and GND of the P6 connector. Check the resistance  
between these to points. If greater then 20,000 ohms  
check the tightness of the connections and the wire  
wiring between the Unit Controller and the space sensor.  
If both are okay and the resistance is still greater then  
20,000 ohms replace the space sensor reset.  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
166  
FORM 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
Supply Air Temperature Cooling Alarm (38)  
Space Temperature Trending Alarm (41)  
The Unit Controller compares the supply air temperature  
to the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR COOLING”  
and initiates the alarm based on the following criteria:  
This alarm will be generated based on the following  
criteria:  
• The SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TEMP”  
and the “SPACE TEMPERATURE ALARM  
TIME” must be set.  
• All the stages of cooling have been on for 10 or  
more minutes.  
• The supply air temperature is 20 or more degrees  
above the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR  
COOLING” set point for 10 minutes.  
• The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more warmer  
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR  
COOLING” set point.  
• The unit has been in a given mode of operation  
for 10 minutes.  
• The temperature is below or above the space  
temperature set point and the trend continues to  
be away from the space temperature set point and  
the “SPACE TEMP TRENDING ALARM TIME”  
has expired.  
• The outdoor air damper is not open more then  
20%.  
Duct Static Low Pressure Alarm (42)  
Supply Air Temperature Heating Alarm (39)  
This alarm is initiated on a VAV unit if after 35 seconds  
of supply fan operation the duct static pressure is not  
equal to or greater then 0.05” WC. When the alarm  
becomes active the unit stops all operation and locks out.  
This can be the result of a faulty Duct Static Pressure  
Transducer or in the transition from an unoccupied to  
occupied mode if the VAV boxes are wide open.  
The Unit Controller compares the supply air temperature  
to the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR HEATING”  
and initiates the alarm based on the following criteria:  
• All the stages of heating have been on for 10 or  
more minutes.  
• The supply air temperature is 20 or more degrees  
below the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR  
HEATING” set point for 10 minutes.  
• The outdoor air is not 20.0° F or more cooler  
then the “SUPPLY AIR TEMP ALARM FOR  
HEATING” set point.  
To check the operation of the duct static transducer  
measure the VDC input between terminal DP+ wire  
337 at the P21 connector and terminal DP- wire 338  
at the P21 connector. Compare the voltage verses  
the duct pressure the control indicates to Table 8-2 in  
this section of the manual. Also verify that 24 VAC is  
present between terminals “COM” and “EXC” at the  
duct static transducer.  
• The outdoor air damper is not open more then  
20%.  
Hot Water Coil Freeze Alarm (43)  
Economizer Minimum Position Alarm (40)  
The alarm indicates the hydronic freeze stat switch has  
opened. The 24 VAC source originates at the terminal  
FSP, wire 389. The input to the control originates at  
terminal FSI, wire 388.  
Prior to declaring this fault the Unit Controller checks the  
outside air temperature and the economizer position. If  
the outside air temperature is more then 20.0° F warmer  
then the set point and the economizer is open more then  
20%, the Unit Controller will close the economizer for  
10 minutes and then check the supply air temperature.  
If the SAT falls below the set point, the control will  
declare an economizer minimum position alarm. The  
Unit Controller will keep the economizer closed until  
the end of the cooling cycle. It will then return the  
economizer damper to its minimum position.  
8
167  
JOHNSON CONTROLS  
Tele. 800-861-1001  
www.york.com  
P.O. Box 1592, York, Pennsylvania USA 17405-1592  
Copyright © by Johnson Controls 2007  
Subject to change without notice. Printed in USA  
ALL RIGHTS RESERVED  
Form 100.50-NOM6 (1207)  
New Release  

Source Technologies Ac018x1222a User Manual
Sanyo N 250aaac User Manual
Sanyo 36xls32a User Manual
Samsung Aw147jb User Manual
Murphy Lube Level Regulator Lr857 User Manual
Makita Xru11 User Manual
LG 55VM5B 02 User Manual
DEZCTOP D BOARD DA DBSVM2 WH1 User Manual
DELL WM126 User Manual
BROTHER FAX 2940 User Manual